blob: 0aac7e931582372b418fc4ece730228dd9325887 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau15480d72014-06-19 21:10:58 +02005 version 1.6
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau9229f122014-06-19 21:01:06 +02007 2014/06/19
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200727.3.1. Converters
737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
777.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079
808. Logging
818.1. Log levels
828.2. Log formats
838.2.1. Default log format
848.2.2. TCP log format
858.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100868.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100878.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200888.3. Advanced logging options
898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
938.4. Timing events
948.5. Session state at disconnection
958.6. Non-printable characters
968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
988.9. Examples of logs
99
1009. Statistics and monitoring
1019.1. CSV format
1029.2. Unix Socket commands
103
104
1051. Quick reminder about HTTP
106----------------------------
107
108When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
109fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
110on almost anything found in the contents.
111
112However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
113formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
114correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
115
116
1171.1. The HTTP transaction model
118-------------------------------
119
120The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100121to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
123connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
124will involve a new connection :
125
126 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
127
128In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
129establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
130by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
131length.
132
133Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
134to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
135however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
136response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
137header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
138
139 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
140
141Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
142power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
143but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200144a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145
146A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
147keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
148second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
149page :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
154latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
155correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
156the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100157server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100159By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
160connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
161leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
162start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
165 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
166 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
167 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
168 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
169 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
170 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
1731.2. HTTP request
174-----------------
175
176First, let's consider this HTTP request :
177
178 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100179 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
181 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
182 3 User-agent: my small browser
183 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
184 5 Accept: image/png
185
186
1871.2.1. The Request line
188-----------------------
189
190Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
191
192 - a METHOD : GET
193 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
194 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
195
196All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
197which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
198followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
199is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
200desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
201the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
202
203The URI itself can have several forms :
204
205 - A "relative URI" :
206
207 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
210 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
211
212 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
213
214 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
217 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
218 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
219 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
220 must accept this form too.
221
222 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
223 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
224 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
227 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
228 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
229 other protocols too.
230
231In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
232mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
233on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
234It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
235specific to the language, framework or application in use.
236
237
2381.2.2. The request headers
239--------------------------
240
241The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
242beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
243an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
244Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
245values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
246encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
247the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
248define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
249
250Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
251their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
252"Connection:" header).
253
254The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
255that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
256is one valid form of empty line.
257
258Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
259headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
260about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
261application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
262
263Important note:
264 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
265 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
266 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
267 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
268
269
2701.3. HTTP response
271------------------
272
273An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
274messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
275
276 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100277 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200278 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
279 2 Content-length: 350
280 3 Content-Type: text/html
281
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200282As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
283codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
284response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100285continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
286the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
287following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
288sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
289(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
290correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
291such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
292state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
293over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
294if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
295information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
2981.3.1. The Response line
299------------------------
300
301Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
302
303 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
304 - a status code : 200
305 - a reason : OK
306
307The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200308 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
310 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
311 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
312 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
313
314Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100315"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
317messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
318or "Authentication Required".
319
320Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
321
322 Code When / reason
323 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
324 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
326 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100327 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200329 400 for an invalid or too large request
330 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
331 accessing the stats page)
332 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
333 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
334 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
335 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
336 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
337 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
338 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
339 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
340 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
341
342The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3434.2).
344
345
3461.3.2. The response headers
347---------------------------
348
349Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
350the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
351details.
352
353
3542. Configuring HAProxy
355----------------------
356
3572.1. Configuration file format
358------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200359
360HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
361
362 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
363 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
364 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
365 "frontend" and "backend".
366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100367The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
368referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
369delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100370preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100371escaped by doubling them.
372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
3742.2. Time format
375----------------
376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100377Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100378values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
379otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
380numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
381for every keyword. Supported units are :
382
383 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
384 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
385 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
386 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
387 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
388 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
389
390
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003912.3. Examples
392-------------
393
394 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
395 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
396 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
397 global
398 daemon
399 maxconn 256
400
401 defaults
402 mode http
403 timeout connect 5000ms
404 timeout client 50000ms
405 timeout server 50000ms
406
407 frontend http-in
408 bind *:80
409 default_backend servers
410
411 backend servers
412 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
413
414
415 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
416 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
417 global
418 daemon
419 maxconn 256
420
421 defaults
422 mode http
423 timeout connect 5000ms
424 timeout client 50000ms
425 timeout server 50000ms
426
427 listen http-in
428 bind *:80
429 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
430
431
432Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
433
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100434 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200435
436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004373. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438--------------------
439
440Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
441are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
442of them have command-line equivalents.
443
444The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
445
446 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200447 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200449 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - daemon
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900451 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200452 - gid
453 - group
454 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100455 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200456 - nbproc
457 - pidfile
458 - uid
459 - ulimit-n
460 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200461 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100462 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200463 - node
464 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100465 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100466
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200467 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200468 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200469 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200470 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100471 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100472 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100473 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200474 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200475 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200476 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200477 - noepoll
478 - nokqueue
479 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100480 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300481 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200482 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200483 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200484 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100485 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100486 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200487 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100488 - tune.idletimer
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100489 - tune.maxaccept
490 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200491 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200492 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100493 - tune.rcvbuf.client
494 - tune.rcvbuf.server
495 - tune.sndbuf.client
496 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100497 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100498 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200499 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100500 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200501 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100502 - tune.zlib.memlevel
503 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100504
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200505 * Debugging
506 - debug
507 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200508
509
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005103.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200511------------------------------------
512
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200513ca-base <dir>
514 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200515 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
516 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200517
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200518chroot <jail dir>
519 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
520 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
521 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
522 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
523 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
524 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100525
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100526cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
527 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
528 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
529 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100530 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
531 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
532 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
533 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
534 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
535 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
536 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
537 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
538 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
539 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100540
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200541crt-base <dir>
542 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
543 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
544 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
545
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200546daemon
547 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
548 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
549 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
550
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900551external-check
552 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
553 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
554 See "option external-check".
555
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200556gid <number>
557 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
558 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
559 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100560 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
561 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200562 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100563
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200564group <group name>
565 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
566 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100567
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200568log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200569 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
570 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100571 configured with "log global".
572
573 <address> can be one of:
574
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100575 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100576 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
577 port).
578
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100579 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
580 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
581 port).
582
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100583 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
584 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
585 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
586 writeable).
587
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100588 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
589 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
590 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
591 in Bourne shell.
592
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200593 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
594 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
595 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
596 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
597 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
598 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
599 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
600 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
601 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
602 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
603 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
604
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100605 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200606
607 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
608 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
609 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
610
611 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200612 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
613 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
614 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
615 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
616 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
617 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200618
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200619 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200620
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100621log-send-hostname [<string>]
622 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
623 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
624 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
625 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
626 the logs.
627
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000628log-tag <string>
629 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
630 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
631 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100632 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000633
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200634nbproc <number>
635 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
636 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
637 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
638 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
639 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
640
641pidfile <pidfile>
642 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
643 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
644 starting the process. See also "daemon".
645
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100646stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200647 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
648 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
649 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
650 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
651 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
652 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100653 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200654 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
655 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200656
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100657ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
658 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
659 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300660 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100661 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
662 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
663 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
664 "bind" keyword for more information.
665
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100666ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
667 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
668 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
669 keyword to see available options.
670
671 Example:
672 global
673 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
674
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100675ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
676 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
677 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300678 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100679 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
680 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
681 information.
682
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100683ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
684 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
685 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
686 keyword to see available options.
687
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100688ssl-server-verify [none|required]
689 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
690 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
691 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
692
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200693stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
694 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
695 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
696 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
697 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200698
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200699 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
700 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
701 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200702
703stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
704 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
705 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100706 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200707
708stats maxconn <connections>
709 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
710 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
711
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200712uid <number>
713 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
714 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
715 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
716 one. See also "gid" and "user".
717
718ulimit-n <number>
719 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
720 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
721 option.
722
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100723unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
724 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
725
726 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
727 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
728 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
729 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
730 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
731 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
732 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
733 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
734 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
735 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
736
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200737user <user name>
738 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
739 See also "uid" and "group".
740
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200741node <name>
742 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
743
744 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
745 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
746 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
747 traffic.
748
749description <text>
750 Add a text that describes the instance.
751
752 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
753 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
754 "<" and ">" characters.
755
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200756
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007573.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200758-----------------------
759
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200760max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
761 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
762 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
763 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
764 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
765 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
766 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
767 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
768 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
769
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200770maxconn <number>
771 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
772 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
773 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200774 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
775 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
776 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
777 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100778 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
779 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
780 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
781 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
782 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200783
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200784maxconnrate <number>
785 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
786 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
787 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
788 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
789 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
790 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
791 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
792 fairness.
793
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100794maxcomprate <number>
795 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300796 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100797 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
798 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
799 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
800 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
801 default value.
802
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100803maxcompcpuusage <number>
804 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
805 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
806 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
807 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
808 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
809 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
810 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
811 process down and from introducing high latencies.
812
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100813maxpipes <number>
814 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
815 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
816 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
817 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
818 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
819 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
820
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200821maxsessrate <number>
822 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
823 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
824 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
825 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
826 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
827 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
828 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
829 fairness.
830
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200831maxsslconn <number>
832 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
833 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
834 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
835 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
836 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
837 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
838 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100839 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
840 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
841 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
842 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
843 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
844 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
845 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200846
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200847maxsslrate <number>
848 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
849 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
850 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
851 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
852 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
853 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
854 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
855 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
856 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
857 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
858
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100859maxzlibmem <number>
860 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
861 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
862 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100863 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
864 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
865 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
866
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200867noepoll
868 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
869 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100870 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200871
872nokqueue
873 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
874 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
875 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
876
877nopoll
878 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
879 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100880 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100881 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200882
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100883nosplice
884 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
885 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
886 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100887 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100888 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
889 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
890 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
891 "option splice-response".
892
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300893nogetaddrinfo
894 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
895 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
896
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200897spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900898 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
899 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
900 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
901 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
902 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
903 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200904
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +0100905tune.buffers.limit <number>
906 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
907 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
908 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
909 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
910 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
911 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
912 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
913 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
914 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
915 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
916 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
917 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
918 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
919 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
920 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
921
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +0100922tune.buffers.reserve <number>
923 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
924 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
925 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
926 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
927
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200928tune.bufsize <number>
929 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
930 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
931 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
932 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
933 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
934 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
935 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
936 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400937 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
938 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
939 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200940
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200941tune.chksize <number>
942 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
943 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
944 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
945 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
946 checks whenever possible.
947
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100948tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
949 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
950 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
951 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
952 this value. The default value is 1.
953
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100954tune.http.cookielen <number>
955 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
956 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
957 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
958 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
959 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
960 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
961 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
962 to change this value.
963
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200964tune.http.maxhdr <number>
965 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
966 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
967 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
968 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
969 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
970 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
971 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
972 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
973 limit too high.
974
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100975tune.idletimer <timeout>
976 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
977 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
978 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
979 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
980 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
981 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
982 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
983 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
984 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
985
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100986tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100987 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
988 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
989 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
990 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
991 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
992 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
993 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
994 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
995 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
996 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100997
998tune.maxpollevents <number>
999 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1000 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1001 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1002 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1003 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1004
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001005tune.maxrewrite <number>
1006 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1007 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1008 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1009 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1010 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1011 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1012 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1013 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1014 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1015 bufsize.
1016
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001017tune.pipesize <number>
1018 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1019 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1020 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1021 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1022 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1023 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1024
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001025tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1026tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1027 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1028 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1029 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1030 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1031 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1032 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1033 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1034
1035tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1036tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1037 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1038 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1039 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1040 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1041 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1042 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1043 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1044 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1045 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1046 notifying haproxy again.
1047
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001048tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001049 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1050 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1051 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001052 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001053 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1054 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1055 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1056 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1057 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001058 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1059 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001060
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001061tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1062 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1063 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1064 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1065 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1066 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1067 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1068
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001069tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1070 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001071 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001072 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1073 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1074 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1075 being used for too long.
1076
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001077tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1078 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1079 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1080 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1081 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1082 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1083 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1084 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1085 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1086 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1087 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001088 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1089 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001090
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001091tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1092 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1093 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1094 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1095 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1096 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1097 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1098 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
1099 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied via the certificate file.
1100
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001101tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1102 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001103 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001104 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1105 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1106 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1107
1108tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1109 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1110 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1111 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1112 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001113
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011143.3. Debugging
1115--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001116
1117debug
1118 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1119 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1120 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1121 system startup.
1122
1123quiet
1124 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1125 line argument "-q".
1126
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001127
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011283.4. Userlists
1129--------------
1130It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1131http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1132it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1133
1134userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001135 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001136 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1137
1138group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001139 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001140 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1141 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1142
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001143user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1144 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001145 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1146 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001147 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1148 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001149 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001150 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001151
1152
1153 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001154 userlist L1
1155 group G1 users tiger,scott
1156 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001157
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001158 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1159 user scott insecure-password elgato
1160 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001161
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001162 userlist L2
1163 group G1
1164 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001165
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001166 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1167 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1168 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001169
1170 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001171
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001172
11733.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001174----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001175It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1176haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1177pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1178identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1179or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1180Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1181known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1182the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1183process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1184during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1185tables.
1186
1187peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001188 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001189 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1190
1191peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1192 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1193 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1194 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1195 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1196 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1197 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1198
1199 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1200 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1201
1202 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1203 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1204 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1205 across all peers.
1206
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001207 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1208 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1209 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1210
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001211 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001212 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001213 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1214 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1215 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001216
1217 backend mybackend
1218 mode tcp
1219 balance roundrobin
1220 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1221 stick on src
1222
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001223 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1224 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001225
1226
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090012273.6. Mailers
1228------------
1229It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1230If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1231in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1232
1233mailer <mailersect>
1234 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1235 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1236
1237mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1238 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1239
1240 Example:
1241 mailers mymailers
1242 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1243 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1244
1245 backend mybackend
1246 mode tcp
1247 balance roundrobin
1248
1249 email-alert mailers mymailers
1250 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1251 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1252
1253 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1254 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1255
1256
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012574. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001258----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001259
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001260Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1261 - defaults <name>
1262 - frontend <name>
1263 - backend <name>
1264 - listen <name>
1265
1266A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1267its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1268section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001269section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001270
1271A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1272connections.
1273
1274A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1275to forward incoming connections.
1276
1277A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1278parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1279
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001280All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1281'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1282case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1283
1284Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1285logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1286proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1287However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1288name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1289
1290Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1291and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001292bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001293protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1294modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1295arbitrary criteria.
1296
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001297In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1298a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1299the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1300
1301 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1302 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1303 between responses and new requests.
1304
1305 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1306 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1307 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1308 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1309
1310 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1311 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1312 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1313
1314 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1315 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1316 client-facing connection remains open.
1317
1318 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1319 after the end of the response.
1320
1321The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1322frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1323following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1324weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1325
1326 Backend mode
1327
1328 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1329 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1330 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1331 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1332 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1333 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1334 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1335 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1336 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1337 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1338 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1339
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001340
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001341
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013424.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1343--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001344
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001345The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1346limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1347they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1348limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001349marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001350option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001351and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1352with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1353specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001354
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001355
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001356 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1357------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1358acl - X X X
1359appsession - - X X
1360backlog X X X -
1361balance X - X X
1362bind - X X -
1363bind-process X X X X
1364block - X X X
1365capture cookie - X X -
1366capture request header - X X -
1367capture response header - X X -
1368clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001369compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001370contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1371cookie X - X X
1372default-server X - X X
1373default_backend X X X -
1374description - X X X
1375disabled X X X X
1376dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001377email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001378email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001379email-alert mailers X X X X
1380email-alert myhostname X X X X
1381email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001382enabled X X X X
1383errorfile X X X X
1384errorloc X X X X
1385errorloc302 X X X X
1386-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1387errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001388force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001389fullconn X - X X
1390grace X X X X
1391hash-type X - X X
1392http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001393http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001394http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001395http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001396http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001397http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001398id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001399ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001400log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001401log-format X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001402log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001403max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001404maxconn X X X -
1405mode X X X X
1406monitor fail - X X -
1407monitor-net X X X -
1408monitor-uri X X X -
1409option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1410option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1411option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1412option allbackups (*) X - X X
1413option checkcache (*) X - X X
1414option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1415option contstats (*) X X X -
1416option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1417option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1418option forceclose (*) X X X X
1419-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1420option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001421option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001422option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001423option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001424option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001425option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001426option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1427option httpchk X - X X
1428option httpclose (*) X X X X
1429option httplog X X X X
1430option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001431option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001432option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001433option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001434option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1435option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1436option logasap (*) X X X -
1437option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001438option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001439option nolinger (*) X X X X
1440option originalto X X X X
1441option persist (*) X - X X
1442option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001443option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001444option smtpchk X - X X
1445option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1446option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1447option splice-request (*) X X X X
1448option splice-response (*) X X X X
1449option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1450option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1451-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001452option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001453option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1454option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1455option tcpka X X X X
1456option tcplog X X X X
1457option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001458external-check command X - X X
1459external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001460persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1461rate-limit sessions X X X -
1462redirect - X X X
1463redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1464redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1465reqadd - X X X
1466reqallow - X X X
1467reqdel - X X X
1468reqdeny - X X X
1469reqiallow - X X X
1470reqidel - X X X
1471reqideny - X X X
1472reqipass - X X X
1473reqirep - X X X
1474reqisetbe - X X X
1475reqitarpit - X X X
1476reqpass - X X X
1477reqrep - X X X
1478-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1479reqsetbe - X X X
1480reqtarpit - X X X
1481retries X - X X
1482rspadd - X X X
1483rspdel - X X X
1484rspdeny - X X X
1485rspidel - X X X
1486rspideny - X X X
1487rspirep - X X X
1488rsprep - X X X
1489server - - X X
1490source X - X X
1491srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001492stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001493stats auth X - X X
1494stats enable X - X X
1495stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001496stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001497stats realm X - X X
1498stats refresh X - X X
1499stats scope X - X X
1500stats show-desc X - X X
1501stats show-legends X - X X
1502stats show-node X - X X
1503stats uri X - X X
1504-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1505stick match - - X X
1506stick on - - X X
1507stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001508stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001509stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001510tcp-check connect - - X X
1511tcp-check expect - - X X
1512tcp-check send - - X X
1513tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001514tcp-request connection - X X -
1515tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001516tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001517tcp-response content - - X X
1518tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001519timeout check X - X X
1520timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001521timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001522timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1523timeout connect X - X X
1524timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1525timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1526timeout http-request X X X X
1527timeout queue X - X X
1528timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001529timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001530timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1531timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001532timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001533transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001534unique-id-format X X X -
1535unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001536use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001537use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001538------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1539 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001540
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001541
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015424.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1543---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001544
1545This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1546
1547
1548acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1549 Declare or complete an access list.
1550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1551 no | yes | yes | yes
1552 Example:
1553 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1554 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1555 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1556
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001557 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001558
1559
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001560appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1561 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001562 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1563 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1564 no | no | yes | yes
1565 Arguments :
1566 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1567 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1568
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001569 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001570 checked in each cookie value.
1571
1572 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1573 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1574 milliseconds.
1575
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001576 request-learn
1577 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1578 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1579 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1580 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1581 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1582 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1583
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001584 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1585 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1586 data following this prefix.
1587
1588 Example :
1589 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1590
1591 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1592 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1593
1594 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1595 2 modes are currently supported :
1596 - path-parameters :
1597 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1598 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1599 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1600 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1601 - query-string :
1602 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1603 query string.
1604
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001605 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1606 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1607 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1608 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001609 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1610 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1611 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001612 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1613 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1614
1615 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1616
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001617 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1618 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1619 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1620
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001621 Example :
1622 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1623
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001624 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1625 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001626
1627
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001628backlog <conns>
1629 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1631 yes | yes | yes | no
1632 Arguments :
1633 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1634 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001635 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001636
1637 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1638 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1639 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1640 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1641 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1642 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1643 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1644 backlog parameter.
1645
1646 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1647 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1648 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1649
1650 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1651
1652
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001653balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001654balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001655 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1657 yes | no | yes | yes
1658 Arguments :
1659 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1660 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1661 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1662 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1663
1664 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1665 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1666 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1667 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001668 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001669 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001670 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1671 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1672 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1673 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1674 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1675 it, so that you don't worry.
1676
1677 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1678 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1679 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1680 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1681 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1682 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1683 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1684 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001685
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001686 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1687 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1688 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1689 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1690 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1691 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1692 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1693 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1694
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001695 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001696 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001697 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1698 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001699 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001700 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1701 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1702 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1703 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1704 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001705 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1706 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1707 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1708 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1709 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1710 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001711
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001712 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1713 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1714 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1715 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1716 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1717 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1718 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1719 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001720 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001721 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001722 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1723 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1724 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001725
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001726 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1727 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1728 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1729 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1730 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1731 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1732 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1733 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1734 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1735 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1736 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1737 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001738
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001739 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001740 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1741 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1742 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1743 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1744 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1745 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1746 URIs start with a leading "/".
1747
1748 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1749 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1750 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1751 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1752
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001753 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001754 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1755
1756 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001757 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1758 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001759 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1760 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1761 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1762 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001763 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001764 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1765 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001766
1767 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1768 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1769 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1770 server will receive the request.
1771
1772 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1773 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1774 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1775 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1776 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001777 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1778 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1779 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001780
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001781 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1782 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1783 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1784 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1785 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001786
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001787 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001788 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1789 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1790 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1791
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001792 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1793 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1794 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1795
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001796 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001797 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001798 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1799 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1800 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1801 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1802 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1803 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001804 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001805 used instead.
1806
1807 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1808 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1809 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1810 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1811
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001812 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1813 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1814 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1815
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001816 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001817
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001818 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001819 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1820 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001821
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001822 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1823 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1824 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001825
1826 Examples :
1827 balance roundrobin
1828 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001829 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001830 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1831 balance hdr(host)
1832 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001833
1834 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1835 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1836
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001837 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001838 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1839 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1840 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1841 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1842
1843 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1844 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1845 defaults to 16 kB.
1846
1847 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1848 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1849
1850 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1851 Round Robin.
1852
1853 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1854 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1855 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1856 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1857
1858 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1859
1860 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001861 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001862 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1863 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1864 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001865
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001866 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1867 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001868
1869
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001870bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1871bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001872 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1874 no | yes | yes | no
1875 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001876 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1877 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1878 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1879 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001880 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001881 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1882 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1883 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1884 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1885 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1886 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1887 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02001888 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
1889 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
1890 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
1891 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
1892 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
1893 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
1894 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001895 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1896 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1897 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001898 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1899 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1900 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1901 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001902
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001903 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1904 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001905 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1906 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1907 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001908 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1909 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1910 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1911 the range.
1912
1913 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1914 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1915 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1916 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1917 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1918 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1919 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001920 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001921 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001922
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001923 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1924 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1925 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1926 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1927 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1928 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1929 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1930 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1931
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001932 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1933 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1934 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1935 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001936
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001937 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1938 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1939 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1940 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1941 in a frontend.
1942
1943 Example :
1944 listen http_proxy
1945 bind :80,:443
1946 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001947 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001948
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001949 listen http_https_proxy
1950 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001951 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001952
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001953 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1954 bind ipv6@:80
1955 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1956 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1957
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001958 listen external_bind_app1
1959 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1960
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001961 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001962 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001963
1964
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001965bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001966 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1968 yes | yes | yes | yes
1969 Arguments :
1970 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1971 may be used to override a default value.
1972
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001973 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001974 option may be combined with other numbers.
1975
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001976 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001977 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1978 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1979 missing from all processes.
1980
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001981 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001982 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02001983 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
1984 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
1985 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
1986 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001987
1988 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1989 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1990 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1991 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1992 and 'even' instances.
1993
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001994 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
1995 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
1996 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
1997 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001998
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001999 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2000 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2001
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002002 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2003 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2004 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2005
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002006 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2007 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2008
2009 Example :
2010 listen app_ip1
2011 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002012 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002013
2014 listen app_ip2
2015 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002016 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002017
2018 listen management
2019 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002020 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002021
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002022 listen management
2023 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2024 bind-process 1-4
2025
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002026 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002027
2028
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002029block { if | unless } <condition>
2030 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2032 no | yes | yes | yes
2033
2034 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2035 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002036 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002037 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002038 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2039 "block" statements per instance.
2040
2041 Example:
2042 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2043 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2044 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2045 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2046
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002047 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002048
2049
2050capture cookie <name> len <length>
2051 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2053 no | yes | yes | no
2054 Arguments :
2055 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2056 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2057 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2058 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2059 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2060
2061 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2062 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2063 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2064 right if it exceeds <length>.
2065
2066 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2067 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2068 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2069 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2070
2071 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2072 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2073 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2074
2075 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2076 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2077 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002078 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2079 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2080 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002081
2082 Example:
2083 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2084
2085 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002086 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002087
2088
2089capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002090 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2092 no | yes | yes | no
2093 Arguments :
2094 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002095 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002096 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2097 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2098 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2099
2100 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2101 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2102 it exceeds <length>.
2103
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002104 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002105 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2106 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002107 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2108 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2109 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2110 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002111 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002112 environments to find where the request came from.
2113
2114 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2115 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2116 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2117 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002118
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002119 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2120 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2121 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2122 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2123 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002124
2125 Example:
2126 capture request header Host len 15
2127 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2128 capture request header Referrer len 15
2129
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002130 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002131 about logging.
2132
2133
2134capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002135 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2137 no | yes | yes | no
2138 Arguments :
2139 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002140 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002141 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2142 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2143 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2144
2145 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2146 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2147 it exceeds <length>.
2148
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002149 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002150 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2151 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2152 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002153 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2154 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2155 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2156 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002157
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002158 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2159 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2160 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2161 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2162 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002163
2164 Example:
2165 capture response header Content-length len 9
2166 capture response header Location len 15
2167
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002168 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002169 about logging.
2170
2171
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002172clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002173 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2175 yes | yes | yes | no
2176 Arguments :
2177 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2178 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2179 as explained at the top of this document.
2180
2181 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2182 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2183 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2184 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2185 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2186 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2187 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2188 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002189 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002190 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2191 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2192
2193 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2194 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2195 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2196 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2197 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2198 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2199
2200 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2201 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2202
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002203 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2204 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002205
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002206compression algo <algorithm> ...
2207compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002208compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002209 Enable HTTP compression.
2210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2211 yes | yes | yes | yes
2212 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002213 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2214 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2215 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2216
2217 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002218 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002219 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2220 data.
2221
2222 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2223 support for zlib was built in.
2224
2225 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2226 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
2227 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
2228 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
2229 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
2230 in.
2231
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002232 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002233 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002234 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2235 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2236 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2237 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2238 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002239
2240 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2241 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2242 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2243 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2244 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002245 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2246 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2247 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2248 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2249 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002250 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2251 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002252
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002253 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002254 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2255 "Accept-Encoding" header
2256 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002257 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002258 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2259 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002260 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2261 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2262 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2263 "multipart"
2264 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2265 header
2266 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2267 and later
2268 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2269 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002270
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002271 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2272 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002273
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002274 Examples :
2275 compression algo gzip
2276 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002277
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002278contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002279 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2280 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2281 yes | no | yes | yes
2282 Arguments :
2283 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2284 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2285 as explained at the top of this document.
2286
2287 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002288 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002289 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002290 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2291 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2292 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2293 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2294
2295 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2296 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2297 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2298 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2299 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2300 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2301
2302 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2303 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2304 instead.
2305
2306 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2307 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2308
2309
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002310cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002311 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2312 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002313 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2315 yes | no | yes | yes
2316 Arguments :
2317 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2318 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2319 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2320 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2321 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2322 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2323 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2324 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2325 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2326
2327 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2328 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2329 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2330 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2331 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2332 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2333 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2334 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2335 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2336 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2337 "insert" and "prefix".
2338
2339 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002340 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002341
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002342 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002343 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2344 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2345 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2346 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2347 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2348 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2349 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2350 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2351 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2352 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002353
2354 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2355 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2356 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2357 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2358 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2359 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2360 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2361 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2362 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2363 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002364 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2365 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2366 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002367
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002368 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2369 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2370 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002371 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2372 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2373 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2374 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002375 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2376 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2377 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002378
2379 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2380 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2381 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2382 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2383 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2384 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2385 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2386 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2387 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2388
2389 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2390 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2391 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2392 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2393 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2394 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2395 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2396 persistence cookie in the cache.
2397 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2398
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002399 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2400 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2401 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2402 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2403 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2404 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2405 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2406 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2407 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2408 they logout.
2409
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002410 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2411 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2412 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2413 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2414
2415 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2416 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2417 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2418 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2419 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2420 this attribute.
2421
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002422 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002423 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002424 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2425 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2426 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2427 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2428 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2429 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002430
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002431 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2432 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2433 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2434 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2435 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2436 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2437 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2438 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2439 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2440 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2441 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2442 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2443 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2444 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2445 the site.
2446
2447 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2448 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2449 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2450 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2451 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2452 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2453 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2454 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2455 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2456 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2457 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2458 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2459 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2460 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2461 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2462 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2463
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002464 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2465 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2466 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2467 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002468
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002469 Examples :
2470 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2471 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2472 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002473 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002474
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002475 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002476 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002477
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002478
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002479default-server [param*]
2480 Change default options for a server in a backend
2481 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2482 yes | no | yes | yes
2483 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002484 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2485 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2486 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2487 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002488
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002489 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002490 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2491
2492 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002493
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002494
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002495default_backend <backend>
2496 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2498 yes | yes | yes | no
2499 Arguments :
2500 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2501
2502 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2503 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2504 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2505 will catch all undetermined requests.
2506
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002507 Example :
2508
2509 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2510 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2511 default_backend dynamic
2512
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002513 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2514
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002515
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002516description <string>
2517 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2519 no | yes | yes | yes
2520 Arguments : string
2521
2522 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2523 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2524 it describes.
2525 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2526
2527
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002528disabled
2529 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2531 yes | yes | yes | yes
2532 Arguments : none
2533
2534 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2535 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2536 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2537 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2538 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2539 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2540 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2541
2542 See also : "enabled"
2543
2544
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002545dispatch <address>:<port>
2546 Set a default server address
2547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2548 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002549 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002550
2551 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2552 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2553 during start-up.
2554
2555 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2556 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2557 possible with normal servers.
2558
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002559 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002560 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2561 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2562 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2563 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2564
2565 See also : "server"
2566
2567
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002568enabled
2569 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2570 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2571 yes | yes | yes | yes
2572 Arguments : none
2573
2574 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2575 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2576
2577 See also : "disabled"
2578
2579
2580errorfile <code> <file>
2581 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2583 yes | yes | yes | yes
2584 Arguments :
2585 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002586 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002587
2588 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002589 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002590 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002591 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2592 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002593
2594 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2595 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2596 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2597
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002598 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2599
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002600 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2601 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2602 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2603 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2604
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002605 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2606 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2607 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2608 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2609 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2610 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2611
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002612 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2613 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2614 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002615 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002616 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2617
2618 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2619
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002620 Example :
2621 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002622 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002623 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2624 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2625
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002626
2627errorloc <code> <url>
2628errorloc302 <code> <url>
2629 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2631 yes | yes | yes | yes
2632 Arguments :
2633 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002634 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002635
2636 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2637 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2638 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2639 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2640 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2641
2642 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2643 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2644 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2645
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002646 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2647
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002648 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2649 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2650 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2651 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2652 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2653 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2654 request.
2655
2656 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2657
2658
2659errorloc303 <code> <url>
2660 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2662 yes | yes | yes | yes
2663 Arguments :
2664 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2665 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2666
2667 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2668 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2669 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2670 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2671 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2672
2673 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2674 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2675 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2676
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002677 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2678
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002679 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2680 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2681 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2682 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002683 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002684
2685 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2686
2687
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002688email-alert from <emailaddr>
2689 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
2690 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
2691 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2692 yes | yes | yes | yes
2693
2694 Arguments :
2695
2696 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
2697
2698 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
2699 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2700
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002701 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
2702 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
2703
2704
2705email-alert level <level>
2706 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
2707 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
2708 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2709 yes | yes | yes | yes
2710
2711 Arguments :
2712
2713 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
2714 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2715 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
2716
2717 By default level is alert
2718
2719 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
2720 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
2721 for the proxy.
2722
2723 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
2724 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002725 section 3.6 about mailers.
2726
2727
2728email-alert mailers <mailersect>
2729 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
2730 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2731 yes | yes | yes | yes
2732
2733 Arguments :
2734
2735 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
2736
2737 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
2738 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2739
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002740 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
2741 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002742
2743
2744email-alert myhostname <hostname>
2745 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
2746 mailers.
2747 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2748 yes | yes | yes | yes
2749
2750 Arguments :
2751
2752 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
2753
2754 By default the systems hostname is used.
2755
2756 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
2757 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
2758 for the proxy.
2759
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002760 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
2761 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002762
2763
2764email-alert to <emailaddr>
2765 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
2766 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
2767 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2768 yes | yes | yes | yes
2769
2770 Arguments :
2771
2772 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
2773
2774 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
2775 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2776
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002777 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002778 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
2779
2780
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002781force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2782 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2783 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2784 no | yes | yes | yes
2785
2786 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2787 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2788 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2789 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2790 marked down for maintenance operations.
2791
2792 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2793 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2794 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2795 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2796 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2797 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2798 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2799 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2800 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2801
2802 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2803 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2804 is used.
2805
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002806 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002807 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002808
2809
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002810fullconn <conns>
2811 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2813 yes | no | yes | yes
2814 Arguments :
2815 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2816 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2817
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002818 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002819 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002820 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002821 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2822 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2823 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2824 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2825 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002826 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002827
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002828 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2829 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002830 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2831 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2832 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002833
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002834 Example :
2835 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2836 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2837 # connections.
2838 backend dynamic
2839 fullconn 10000
2840 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2841 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2842
2843 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2844
2845
2846grace <time>
2847 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002849 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002850 Arguments :
2851 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2852 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2853 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2854
2855 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2856 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002857 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002858 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2859
2860 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2861 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2862 simplify it.
2863
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002864
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002865hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002866 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2868 yes | no | yes | yes
2869 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002870 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2871 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002872
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002873 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2874 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2875 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2876 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2877 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2878 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2879 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2880 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2881 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2882 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002883
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002884 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2885 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2886 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2887 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2888 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2889 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2890 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2891 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2892 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2893 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2894 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2895 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2896 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002897 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2898 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002899
2900 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2901
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002902 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002903 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2904 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2905 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002906 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2907 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2908 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002909
2910 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2911 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002912 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2913 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2914 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2915 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2916
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002917 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2918 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2919 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2920 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2921 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2922 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2923 parameter.
2924
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01002925 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
2926 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
2927 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
2928 used on strings.
2929
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002930 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2931
2932 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2933 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2934 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2935 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2936 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2937 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2938 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2939 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2940 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2941 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2942 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2943 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002944
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002945 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2946 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2947 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002948
2949 See also : "balance", "server"
2950
2951
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002952http-check disable-on-404
2953 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2954 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002955 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002956 Arguments : none
2957
2958 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2959 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2960 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2961 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2962 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2963 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2964 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2965 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002966 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2967 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2968 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2969
2970 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2971
2972
2973http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002974 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002976 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002977 Arguments :
2978 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2979 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002980 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002981 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2982 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2983 details on the supported keywords.
2984
2985 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2986 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2987 with the usual backslash ('\').
2988
2989 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2990 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2991 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2992 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2993 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2994
2995 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002996 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002997 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2998 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2999 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3000
3001 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003002 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003003 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3004 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3005 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3006 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3007
3008 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003009 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003010 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3011 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3012 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3013 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3014 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3015 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3016 trace).
3017
3018 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003019 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003020 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3021 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3022 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3023 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3024 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3025 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3026
3027 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3028 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3029 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3030 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3031 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3032 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3033 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3034 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3035
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003036 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3037 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3038 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3039
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003040 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3041 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3042
3043 Examples :
3044 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003045 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003046
3047 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003048 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003049
3050 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003051 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003052
3053 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003054 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003055
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003056 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003057
3058
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003059http-check send-state
3060 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3061 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3062 yes | no | yes | yes
3063 Arguments : none
3064
3065 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3066 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3067 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3068 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3069 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3070
3071 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3072 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3073 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3074 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3075 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
3076 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3077 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3078 checked in multiple backends.
3079
3080 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3081 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3082
3083 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3084 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3085 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3086 one fails.
3087
3088 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3089 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3090 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3091
3092 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3093 server's queue.
3094
3095 Example of a header received by the application server :
3096 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3097 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3098
3099 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3100
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003101http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003102 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003103 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003104 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3105 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003106 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3107 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003108 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3109 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3110 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003111 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
3112 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003113 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003114 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003115 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3116
3117 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3118 no | yes | yes | yes
3119
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003120 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3121 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3122 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3123 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3124 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003125
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003126 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3127 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3128 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3129
3130 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3131 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
3132 are evaluated.
3133
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003134 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3135 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3136 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
3137 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
3138 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3139 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3140 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3141 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3142 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003143 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003144 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
3145
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003146 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3147 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3148 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3149 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3150 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3151
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003152 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3153 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3154 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003155 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3156 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003157
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003158 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3159 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3160 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3161 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3162 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3163 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3164 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3165 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3166
3167 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3168 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3169 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003170 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3171 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003172
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003173 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3174 <name>.
3175
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003176 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3177 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3178 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3179 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3180 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3181 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3182 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3183 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3184
3185 Example:
3186
3187 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3188
3189 applied to:
3190
3191 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3192
3193 outputs:
3194
3195 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3196
3197 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3198
3199 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3200 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3201 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3202 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3203 header.
3204
3205 Example:
3206
3207 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3208
3209 applied to:
3210
3211 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3212
3213 outputs:
3214
3215 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3216
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003217 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3218 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3219 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3220 it.
3221
3222 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3223 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3224 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3225 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3226 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3227 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3228
3229 Example :
3230 # prepend the host name before the path
3231 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3232
3233 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3234 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3235 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3236 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3237 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3238 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3239 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3240 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3241
3242 Example :
3243 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3244 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3245
3246 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3247 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3248 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3249 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3250 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3251 "set-query".
3252
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003253 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3254 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3255 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3256 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3257 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3258 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3259 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3260 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3261
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003262 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3263 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3264 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3265 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3266 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3267 another equipment.
3268
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003269 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3270 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3271 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3272 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3273 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3274 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3275 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3276 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3277
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003278 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3279 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3280 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3281 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3282 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3283 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3284 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3285 admin privileges.
3286
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003287 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3288 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3289 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3290 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3291 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3292 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3293 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3294 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3295
3296 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3297 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3298 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3299 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3300 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3301 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3302
3303 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3304 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3305 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3306 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3307 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3308 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3309
3310 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3311 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3312 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3313 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3314 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3315 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3316 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3317 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3318 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3319
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003320 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3321 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3322 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3323 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3324 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3325 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3326 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3327 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3328 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3329 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3330 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3331 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3332
3333 These actions take one or two arguments :
3334 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3335 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3336 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3337 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3338
3339 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3340 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3341 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3342 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3343
3344 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3345 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3346 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3347 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3348 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3349 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3350 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3351 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3352
3353 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3354 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3355 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3356 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3357 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3358
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003359 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3360
3361 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3362 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3363 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3364 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003365
3366 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003367 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3368 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3369 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003370
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003371 http-request allow if nagios
3372 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3373 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3374 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003375
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003376 Example:
3377 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003378 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003379
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003380 Example:
3381 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3382 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3383 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3384 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3385 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3386 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3387 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3388 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3389 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3390
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003391 Example:
3392 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3393 acl add path /addacl
3394 acl del path /delacl
3395
3396 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3397
3398 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3399 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3400
3401 Example:
3402 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3403 acl setmap path /setmap
3404 acl delmap path /delmap
3405
3406 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3407
3408 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3409 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3410
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003411 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3412 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003413
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003414http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003415 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003416 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3417 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003418 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3419 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3420 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3421 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3422 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
3423 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003424 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003425 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3426
3427 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3428 no | yes | yes | yes
3429
3430 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3431 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3432 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3433 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3434 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3435 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3436
3437 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3438 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3439 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3440 current section.
3441
3442 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3443 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3444 rules are evaluated.
3445
3446 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3447 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3448 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3449 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3450 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3451 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3452 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3453
3454 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3455 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3456 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3457 external users.
3458
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003459 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3460 <name>.
3461
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003462 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3463 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3464 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3465 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3466 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3467 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3468 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3469 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3470
3471 Example:
3472
3473 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3474
3475 applied to:
3476
3477 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3478
3479 outputs:
3480
3481 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3482
3483 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3484
3485 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3486 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3487 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3488 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3489 header.
3490
3491 Example:
3492
3493 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3494
3495 applied to:
3496
3497 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3498
3499 outputs:
3500
3501 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3502
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003503 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3504 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3505 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3506 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3507 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3508 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3509 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3510 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3511
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003512 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3513 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3514 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3515 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3516 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3517 another equipment.
3518
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003519 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3520 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3521 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3522 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3523 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3524 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3525 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3526 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3527
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003528 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3529 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3530 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3531 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3532 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3533 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3534 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3535 admin privileges.
3536
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003537 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3538 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3539 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3540 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3541 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3542 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3543 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3544 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3545
3546 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3547 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3548 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3549 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3550 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3551 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3552
3553 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3554 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3555 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3556 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3557 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3558 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3559
3560 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3561 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3562 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3563 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3564 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3565 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3566 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3567 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3568 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3569
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003570 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3571
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003572 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003573 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3574 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3575 rules.
3576
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003577 Example:
3578 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3579
3580 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3581
3582 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3583 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3584
3585 Example:
3586 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3587
3588 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3589
3590 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3591 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3592
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003593 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3594 ACL usage.
3595
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003596
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003597http-send-name-header [<header>]
3598 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3599
3600 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3601 yes | no | yes | yes
3602
3603 Arguments :
3604
3605 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3606
3607 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3608 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3609 is added with the header string proved.
3610
3611 See also : "server"
3612
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003613id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003614 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3615 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3616 no | yes | yes | yes
3617 Arguments : none
3618
3619 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3620 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3621 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003622
3623
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003624ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3625 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3626 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3627 no | yes | yes | yes
3628
3629 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3630 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3631 and running).
3632
3633 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3634 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3635 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003636 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003637 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3638
3639 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3640 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3641
3642 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3643 "unless" condition is met.
3644
3645 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3646
3647
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003648log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003649log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003650no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003651 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3653 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003654
3655 Prefix :
3656 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3657 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3658 prefix does not allow arguments.
3659
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003660 Arguments :
3661 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3662 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3663 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3664 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3665 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3666 parameter.
3667
3668 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3669 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3670
3671 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3672 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3673 standard syslog port).
3674
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003675 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3676 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3677 standard syslog port).
3678
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003679 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3680 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3681 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3682 appropriately writeable).
3683
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003684 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3685 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3686 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3687 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3688
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003689 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
3690 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
3691 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
3692 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
3693 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
3694 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
3695 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
3696 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
3697 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
3698 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
3699 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
3700
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003701 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3702
3703 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3704 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3705 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3706
3707 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3708 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3709 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003710 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3711 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3712 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3713 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3714 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003715
3716 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3717
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003718 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3719 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3720 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003721
3722 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3723 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3724 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3725 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3726
3727 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3728 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003729
3730 Example :
3731 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003732 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3733 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003734 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3735
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003736
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003737log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003738 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
3739 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3740 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003741
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003742 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
3743 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
3744 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
3745 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
3746 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003747
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003748log-tag <string>
3749 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
3750 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3751 yes | yes | yes | yes
3752
3753 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
3754 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
3755 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
3756 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
3757 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
3758 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
3759 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
3760 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
3761 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003762
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003763max-keep-alive-queue <value>
3764 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
3765 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3766 yes | no | yes | yes
3767
3768 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
3769 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
3770 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
3771 servers.
3772
3773 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
3774 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
3775 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
3776 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
3777 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
3778 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
3779 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
3780 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
3781 picking a different server.
3782
3783 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
3784 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
3785 even if they have to be queued.
3786
3787 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
3788 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
3789
3790
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003791maxconn <conns>
3792 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3793 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3794 yes | yes | yes | no
3795 Arguments :
3796 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3797 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3798 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3799 closes.
3800
3801 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3802 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3803 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3804 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3805 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3806 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3807 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3808 properly tuned.
3809
3810 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3811 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3812 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3813
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003814 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3815
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003816 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3817
3818
3819mode { tcp|http|health }
3820 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3822 yes | yes | yes | yes
3823 Arguments :
3824 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3825 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3826 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3827 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3828
3829 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3830 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3831 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3832 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3833 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3834
3835 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003836 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3837 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3838 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3839 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3840 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3841 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3842 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003843
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003844 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3845 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3846 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003847
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003848 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003849 defaults http_instances
3850 mode http
3851
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003852 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003853
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003854
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003855monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003856 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3858 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003859 Arguments :
3860 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3861 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003862 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003863 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3864 backend and its backup.
3865
3866 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3867 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3868 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3869 servers in a list of backends.
3870
3871 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3872 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3873 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3874 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3875 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3876 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3877 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003878 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3879 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003880
3881 Example:
3882 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003883 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003884 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3885 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3886 monitor-uri /site_alive
3887 monitor fail if site_dead
3888
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003889 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003890
3891
3892monitor-net <source>
3893 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3895 yes | yes | yes | no
3896 Arguments :
3897 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3898 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3899 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3900 followed by a mask.
3901
3902 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3903 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003904 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003905 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3906
3907 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3908 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3909 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3910 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003911 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3912 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3913 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003914
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003915 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3916 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3917 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3918 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3919 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3920 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003921
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003922 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3923 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003924
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003925 Example :
3926 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3927 frontend www
3928 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3929
3930 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3931
3932
3933monitor-uri <uri>
3934 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3935 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3936 yes | yes | yes | no
3937 Arguments :
3938 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3939 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3940
3941 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3942 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3943 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3944 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3945 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3946 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3947 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3948 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3949
3950 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3951 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3952 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3953 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3954 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3955 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3956
3957 Example :
3958 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3959 frontend www
3960 mode http
3961 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3962
3963 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3964
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003965
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003966option abortonclose
3967no option abortonclose
3968 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3969 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3970 yes | no | yes | yes
3971 Arguments : none
3972
3973 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3974 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3975 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3976 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003977 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003978 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3979 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3980 encountered while delivering the response.
3981
3982 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3983 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3984 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3985 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3986 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3987 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003988 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003989 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003990 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003991 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3992 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3993 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3994
3995 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3996 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3997 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3998 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3999 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
4000 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
4001 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
4002 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004003 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004004
4005 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4006 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4007
4008 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
4009
4010
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004011option accept-invalid-http-request
4012no option accept-invalid-http-request
4013 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
4014 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4015 yes | yes | yes | no
4016 Arguments : none
4017
4018 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
4019 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4020 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4021 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4022 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4023 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4024 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4025 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004026 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
4027 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
4028 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
4029 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
4030 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
4031 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004032
4033 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4034 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4035 been confirmed.
4036
4037 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4038 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004039 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
4040 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004041 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4042
4043 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4044 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4045
4046 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
4047 stats socket.
4048
4049
4050option accept-invalid-http-response
4051no option accept-invalid-http-response
4052 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
4053 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4054 yes | no | yes | yes
4055 Arguments : none
4056
4057 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
4058 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4059 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4060 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4061 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4062 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4063 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4064 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
4065 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
4066
4067 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4068 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4069 been confirmed.
4070
4071 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4072 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
4073 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
4074 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4075
4076 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4077 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4078
4079 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
4080 stats socket.
4081
4082
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004083option allbackups
4084no option allbackups
4085 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
4086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4087 yes | no | yes | yes
4088 Arguments : none
4089
4090 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
4091 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
4092 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
4093 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
4094 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
4095 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
4096 order between the backup servers anymore.
4097
4098 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
4099 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
4100
4101 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4102 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4103
4104
4105option checkcache
4106no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08004107 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4109 yes | no | yes | yes
4110 Arguments : none
4111
4112 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
4113 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004114 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004115 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
4116 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004117 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004118
4119 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004120 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004121 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004122 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
4123 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004124 to the client are :
4125 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004126 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004127 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004128 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
4129 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
4130 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
4131 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
4132 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
4133 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
4134 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
4135 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
4136 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
4137 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
4138 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
4139
4140 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004141 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004142 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004143 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004144 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
4145
4146 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
4147 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004148 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004149 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
4150
4151 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4152 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4153
4154
4155option clitcpka
4156no option clitcpka
4157 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
4158 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4159 yes | yes | yes | no
4160 Arguments : none
4161
4162 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4163 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4164 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4165 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4166
4167 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4168 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4169 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4170 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4171
4172 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4173 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4174 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4175 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4176 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4177
4178 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4179
4180 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4181 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4182 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
4183
4184 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4185 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4186
4187 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
4188
4189
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004190option contstats
4191 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
4192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4193 yes | yes | yes | no
4194 Arguments : none
4195
4196 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
4197 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
4198 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
4199 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
4200 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
4201 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
4202 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
4203
4204
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004205option dontlog-normal
4206no option dontlog-normal
4207 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
4208 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4209 yes | yes | yes | no
4210 Arguments : none
4211
4212 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
4213 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
4214 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
4215 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
4216 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
4217 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
4218 logged.
4219
4220 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
4221 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
4222 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
4223
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004224 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004225 logging.
4226
4227
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004228option dontlognull
4229no option dontlognull
4230 Enable or disable logging of null connections
4231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4232 yes | yes | yes | no
4233 Arguments : none
4234
4235 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
4236 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
4237 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
4238 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
4239 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
4240 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
4241 which typically corresponds to those probes.
4242
4243 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
4244 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
4245 would not be logged.
4246
4247 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4248 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4249
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004250 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004251
4252
4253option forceclose
4254no option forceclose
4255 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
4256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01004257 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004258 Arguments : none
4259
4260 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
4261 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
4262 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
4263 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
4264 global session times in the logs.
4265
4266 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01004267 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004268 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004269
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004270 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
4271 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
4272 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
4273
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004274 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4275 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004276
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004277 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4278 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4279
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004280 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004281
4282
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004283option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004284 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
4285 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4286 yes | yes | yes | yes
4287 Arguments :
4288 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4289 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004290 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004291 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004292
4293 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
4294 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
4295 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
4296 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
4297 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
4298 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
4299 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004300 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
4301 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4302 possible that the client has already brought one.
4303
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004304 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004305 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004306 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
4307 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004308 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
4309 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004310
4311 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4312 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4313 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4314 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4315 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4316 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4317 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4318
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004319 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
4320 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
4321 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
4322 are under the control of the end-user.
4323
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004324 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004325 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4326 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004327 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
4328 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
4329 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004330
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004331 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004332 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
4333 frontend www
4334 mode http
4335 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
4336
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004337 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
4338 backend www
4339 mode http
4340 option forwardfor header X-Client
4341
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004342 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004343 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004344
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004345
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004346option http-keep-alive
4347no option http-keep-alive
4348 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
4349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4350 yes | yes | yes | yes
4351 Arguments : none
4352
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004353 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4354 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4355 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
4356 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
4357 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4358 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
4359 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
4360
4361 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
4362 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004363 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
4364 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
4365 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
4366 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
4367 situations where this option may be useful :
4368
4369 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
4370 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
4371
4372 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
4373 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
4374
4375 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
4376 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
4377 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
4378 request.
4379
4380 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
4381 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004382 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
4383 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
4384 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004385
4386 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
4387 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
4388
4389 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4390 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4391 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4392 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
4393 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4394 not set.
4395
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004396 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4397 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004398 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004399 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004400
4401 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004402 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
4403 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004404
4405
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004406option http-no-delay
4407no option http-no-delay
4408 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4409 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4410 yes | yes | yes | yes
4411 Arguments : none
4412
4413 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4414 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4415 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4416 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4417 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4418 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4419 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4420 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4421 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4422 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4423 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4424 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4425 affected.
4426
4427 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4428 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4429 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4430 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4431 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4432 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4433 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4434 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4435 latency environments.
4436
4437
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004438option http-pretend-keepalive
4439no option http-pretend-keepalive
4440 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4442 yes | yes | yes | yes
4443 Arguments : none
4444
4445 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4446 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4447 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4448 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4449 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4450 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4451 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4452 consider the response complete.
4453
4454 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4455 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4456 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4457 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4458 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4459 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4460
4461 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4462 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4463 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4464 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4465 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4466 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4467 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4468
4469 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4470 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004471 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004472 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4473 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004474
4475 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4476 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4477
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004478 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4479 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004480
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004481
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004482option http-server-close
4483no option http-server-close
4484 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4485 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4486 yes | yes | yes | yes
4487 Arguments : none
4488
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004489 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4490 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4491 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4492 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4493 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4494 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4495 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4496 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4497 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4498 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4499 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4500 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4501 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4502 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4503 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4504 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004505
4506 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4507 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4508 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4509 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004510 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4511 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004512
4513 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4514 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004515 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4516 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004517 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4518 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004519
4520 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4521 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4522
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004523 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004524 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4525 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004526
4527
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004528option http-tunnel
4529no option http-tunnel
4530 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4532 yes | yes | yes | yes
4533 Arguments : none
4534
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004535 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4536 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4537 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4538 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4539 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4540 "option http-tunnel".
4541
4542 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004543 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004544 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4545 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4546 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4547 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4548 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4549 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4550 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004551
4552 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4553 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4554
4555 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4556 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4557 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4558
4559
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004560option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004561no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004562 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4563 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4564 yes | yes | yes | no
4565 Arguments : none
4566
4567 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4568 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4569 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4570 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4571 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4572 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4573 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4574
4575 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4576 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4577 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4578 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4579 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4580 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4581 request along its whole life.
4582
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004583 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4584 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4585 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4586 front of an existing proxy.
4587
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004588 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4589
4590 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4591 http-server-close".
4592
4593
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004594option httpchk
4595option httpchk <uri>
4596option httpchk <method> <uri>
4597option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4598 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4600 yes | no | yes | yes
4601 Arguments :
4602 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4603 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4604 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4605 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4606 ones.
4607
4608 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4609 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4610 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4611
4612 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4613 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4614 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4615 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4616 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4617
4618 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4619 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4620 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4621 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4622 the lack of any response.
4623
4624 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4625
4626 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4627 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4628 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4629
4630 Examples :
4631 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4632 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4633 backend https_relay
4634 mode tcp
4635 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4636 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4637
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004638 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4639 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4640 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004641
4642
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004643option httpclose
4644no option httpclose
4645 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4647 yes | yes | yes | yes
4648 Arguments : none
4649
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004650 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4651 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4652 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4653 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004654 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004655 "option http-tunnel".
4656
4657 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4658 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4659 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4660 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4661 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4662 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4663 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4664 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004665
4666 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004667 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004668 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4669 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4670 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4671 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4672 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004673
4674 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4675 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004676 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4677 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004678 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4679 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004680
4681 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4682 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4683
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004684 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4685 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004686
4687
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004688option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004689 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4691 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004692 Arguments :
4693 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4694 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4695 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4696 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4697 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004698
4699 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4700 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4701 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4702 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4703 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4704 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4705 ports.
4706
4707 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4708
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01004709 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
4710 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004711
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004712 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004713
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004714
4715option http_proxy
4716no option http_proxy
4717 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4719 yes | yes | yes | yes
4720 Arguments : none
4721
4722 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4723 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4724 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4725 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4726 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4727
4728 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4729 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4730 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4731 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004732 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004733 be analyzed.
4734
4735 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4736 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4737
4738 Example :
4739 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4740 backend direct_forward
4741 option httpclose
4742 option http_proxy
4743
4744 See also : "option httpclose"
4745
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004746
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004747option independent-streams
4748no option independent-streams
4749 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4751 yes | yes | yes | yes
4752 Arguments : none
4753
4754 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4755 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4756 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4757 receive data or not.
4758
4759 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4760 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4761 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4762 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4763 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4764 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4765 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4766 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4767 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4768 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4769 socket buffers.
4770
4771 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4772 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4773 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4774 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4775 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4776
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004777 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004778 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4779 deprecated.
4780
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004781 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004782
4783
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004784option ldap-check
4785 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4787 yes | no | yes | yes
4788 Arguments : none
4789
4790 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4791 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4792 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4793 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4794
4795 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4796 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4797
4798 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4799 configure it.
4800
4801 Example :
4802 option ldap-check
4803
4804 See also : "option httpchk"
4805
4806
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004807option external-check
4808 Use external processes for server health checks
4809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4810 yes | no | yes | yes
4811
4812 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
4813 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
4814 command".
4815
4816 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
4817
4818 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
4819
4820
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004821option log-health-checks
4822no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004823 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4825 yes | no | yes | yes
4826 Arguments : none
4827
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004828 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
4829 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
4830 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004831
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004832 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
4833 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
4834 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
4835 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
4836 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
4837
4838 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
4839 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004840
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004841 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
4842 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
4843 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004844
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004845
4846option log-separate-errors
4847no option log-separate-errors
4848 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4850 yes | yes | yes | no
4851 Arguments : none
4852
4853 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4854 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4855 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4856 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4857 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4858 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4859 provides very important information.
4860
4861 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4862 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4863 error logs.
4864
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004865 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004866 logging.
4867
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004868
4869option logasap
4870no option logasap
4871 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4872 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4873 yes | yes | yes | no
4874 Arguments : none
4875
4876 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4877 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4878 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4879 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4880 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4881 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4882 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004883 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004884 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4885 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4886
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004887 Examples :
4888 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4889 mode http
4890 option httplog
4891 option logasap
4892 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4893
4894 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4895 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4896 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4897 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4898
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004899 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004900 logging.
4901
4902
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004903option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004904 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004905 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4906 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004907 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004908 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4909 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004910 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004911
4912 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4913 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4914 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4915 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4916 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4917 in the MySQL table, like this :
4918
4919 USE mysql;
4920 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4921 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4922
4923 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4924 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4925 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4926 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4927 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4928 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4929 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4930 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4931 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4932
4933 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4934 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004935
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004936 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004937
4938 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4939 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4940 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4941 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4942 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4943 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4944
4945 See also: "option httpchk"
4946
4947
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004948option nolinger
4949no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004950 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004951 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4952 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004953 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004954
4955 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4956 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4957 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4958 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4959 connections.
4960
4961 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4962 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4963 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4964 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4965 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4966 this too.
4967
4968 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4969 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4970 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4971
4972 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4973 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4974 for servers.
4975
4976 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4977 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4978
4979
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004980option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4981 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4983 yes | yes | yes | yes
4984 Arguments :
4985 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4986 matching <network>
4987 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4988 header name.
4989
4990 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4991 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4992 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4993 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4994 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4995 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4996 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4997 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4998 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4999 possible that the client has already brought one.
5000
5001 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
5002 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
5003 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
5004 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
5005 header and requires different one.
5006
5007 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5008 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5009 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5010 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5011 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5012 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5013 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5014
5015 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
5016 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5017 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
5018 both are defined.
5019
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005020 Examples :
5021 # Original Destination address
5022 frontend www
5023 mode http
5024 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
5025
5026 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
5027 backend www
5028 mode http
5029 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
5030
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005031 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
5032 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005033
5034
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005035option persist
5036no option persist
5037 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
5038 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5039 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005040 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005041
5042 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
5043 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
5044 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
5045 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
5046 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
5047 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
5048 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
5049 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
5050 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
5051 redirected to another valid server.
5052
5053 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5054 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5055
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005056 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005057
5058
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01005059option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
5060 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
5061 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5062 yes | no | yes | yes
5063 Arguments :
5064 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
5065 PostgreSQL server.
5066
5067 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
5068 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
5069 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
5070 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
5071
5072 See also: "option httpchk"
5073
5074
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005075option prefer-last-server
5076no option prefer-last-server
5077 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
5078 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5079 yes | no | yes | yes
5080 Arguments : none
5081
5082 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
5083 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
5084 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
5085 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
5086 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
5087 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
5088 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
5089 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
5090 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01005091 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
5092 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
5093 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
5094 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
5095 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
5096 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
5097 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005098
5099 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5100 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5101
5102 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
5103
5104
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005105option redispatch
5106no option redispatch
5107 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5108 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5109 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005110 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005111
5112 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5113 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5114 be able to access the service anymore.
5115
5116 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
5117 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
5118
5119 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5120 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5121 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005122
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005123 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
5124 "redisp" keywords.
5125
5126 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5127 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5128
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005129 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005130
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005131
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02005132option redis-check
5133 Use redis health checks for server testing
5134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5135 yes | no | yes | yes
5136 Arguments : none
5137
5138 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
5139 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
5140 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
5141 find the "+PONG" response message.
5142
5143 Example :
5144 option redis-check
5145
5146 See also : "option httpchk"
5147
5148
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005149option smtpchk
5150option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
5151 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
5152 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5153 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005154 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005155 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
5156 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
5157 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
5158
5159 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
5160 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
5161 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
5162
5163 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
5164 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
5165 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
5166 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
5167 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
5168 dead server.
5169
5170 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
5171 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
5172 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
5173 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
5174
5175 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
5176 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
5177 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5178 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
5179 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
5180
5181 Example :
5182 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
5183
5184 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
5185
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005186
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02005187option socket-stats
5188no option socket-stats
5189
5190 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
5191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5192 yes | yes | yes | no
5193
5194 Arguments : none
5195
5196
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005197option splice-auto
5198no option splice-auto
5199 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
5200 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5201 yes | yes | yes | yes
5202 Arguments : none
5203
5204 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
5205 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
5206 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
5207 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005208 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005209 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
5210 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
5211 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
5212 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5213
5214 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
5215 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
5216 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
5217 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
5218 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
5219 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
5220 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
5221 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
5222 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
5223 keyword.
5224
5225 Example :
5226 option splice-auto
5227
5228 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5229 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5230
5231 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
5232 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5233
5234
5235option splice-request
5236no option splice-request
5237 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
5238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5239 yes | yes | yes | yes
5240 Arguments : none
5241
5242 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005243 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005244 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5245 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5246 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5247 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5248
5249 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5250
5251 Example :
5252 option splice-request
5253
5254 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5255 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5256
5257 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
5258 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5259
5260
5261option splice-response
5262no option splice-response
5263 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
5264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5265 yes | yes | yes | yes
5266 Arguments : none
5267
5268 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005269 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005270 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5271 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5272 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5273 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5274
5275 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5276
5277 Example :
5278 option splice-response
5279
5280 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5281 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5282
5283 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
5284 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5285
5286
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005287option srvtcpka
5288no option srvtcpka
5289 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
5290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5291 yes | no | yes | yes
5292 Arguments : none
5293
5294 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5295 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5296 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5297 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5298
5299 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5300 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5301 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5302 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5303
5304 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5305 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5306 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5307 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5308 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5309
5310 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5311
5312 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5313 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5314 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
5315
5316 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5317 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5318
5319 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
5320
5321
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005322option ssl-hello-chk
5323 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
5324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5325 yes | no | yes | yes
5326 Arguments : none
5327
5328 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
5329 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
5330 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
5331 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
5332 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
5333 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
5334 hello message.
5335
5336 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
5337 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
5338 messages, which is appreciable.
5339
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005340 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
5341 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
5342 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005343
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005344 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
5345
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005346
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005347option tcp-check
5348 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
5349 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5350 yes | no | yes | yes
5351
5352 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
5353 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
5354
5355 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
5356 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
5357 attempt, which remains the default mode.
5358
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005359 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005360 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
5361 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
5362 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
5363 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
5364 only.
5365
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005366 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005367 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
5368 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
5369 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
5370 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
5371
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005372 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005373 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
5374 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005375 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005376 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
5377 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
5378 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
5379 the respective protocols.
5380 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
5381 analysed.
5382
5383 Examples :
5384 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
5385 option tcp-check
5386 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
5387
5388 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
5389 option tcp-check
5390 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
5391
5392 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
5393 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005394 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005395 option tcp-check
5396 tcp-check send PING\r\n
5397 tcp-check expect +PONG
5398 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
5399 tcp-check expect string role:master
5400 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
5401 tcp-check expect string +OK
5402
5403 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
5404 (send many headers before analyzing)
5405 option tcp-check
5406 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
5407 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
5408 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
5409 tcp-check send \r\n
5410 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
5411
5412
5413 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
5414
5415
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005416option tcp-smart-accept
5417no option tcp-smart-accept
5418 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
5419 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5420 yes | yes | yes | no
5421 Arguments : none
5422
5423 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
5424 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
5425 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
5426 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
5427 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
5428 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5429
5430 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5431 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5432 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5433 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5434
5435 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5436 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5437 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5438 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5439
5440 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5441 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5442 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5443
5444 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5445 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5446 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5447
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005448 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5449
5450
5451option tcp-smart-connect
5452no option tcp-smart-connect
5453 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5455 yes | no | yes | yes
5456 Arguments : none
5457
5458 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5459 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5460 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5461 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5462 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5463
5464 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5465 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5466 complex.
5467
5468 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5469 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5470 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5471
5472 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5473 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5474
5475 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5476
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005477
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005478option tcpka
5479 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5481 yes | yes | yes | yes
5482 Arguments : none
5483
5484 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5485 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5486 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5487 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5488
5489 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5490 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5491 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5492 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5493
5494 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5495 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5496 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5497 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5498 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5499
5500 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5501
5502 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5503 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5504 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5505 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5506 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5507 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5508 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5509 backends.
5510
5511 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5512
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005513
5514option tcplog
5515 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5516 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5517 yes | yes | yes | yes
5518 Arguments : none
5519
5520 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5521 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5522 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5523 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5524 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5525 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5526 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5527 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5528
5529 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5530
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005531 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005532
5533
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005534option transparent
5535no option transparent
5536 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5537 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005538 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005539 Arguments : none
5540
5541 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5542 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5543 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5544 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5545 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5546 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5547 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5548 appropriate server.
5549
5550 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5551 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5552
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005553 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005554 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005555
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005556
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005557external-check command <command>
5558 Executable to run when performing an external-check
5559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5560 yes | no | yes | yes
5561
5562 Arguments :
5563 <command> is the external command to run
5564
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005565 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
5566
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01005567 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005568
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01005569 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
5570 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
5571 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
5572 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
5573 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
5574 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005575
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01005576 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
5577
5578 Environment variables :
5579 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
5580 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
5581
5582 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
5583
5584 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
5585
5586 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
5587 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
5588 for a UNIX socket).
5589
5590 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
5591
5592 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
5593
5594 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
5595
5596 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
5597
5598 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
5599
5600 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
5601 socket).
5602
5603 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
5604 the command may be set using "external-check path".
5605
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005606 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
5607 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
5608 failed.
5609
5610 Example :
5611 external-check command /bin/true
5612
5613 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
5614
5615
5616external-check path <path>
5617 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
5618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5619 yes | no | yes | yes
5620
5621 Arguments :
5622 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
5623
5624 The default path is "".
5625
5626 Example :
5627 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
5628
5629 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
5630 "external-check command"
5631
5632
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005633persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005634persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005635 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5636 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5637 yes | no | yes | yes
5638 Arguments :
5639 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005640 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5641 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005642
5643 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5644 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5645 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5646 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5647 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5648 forwarded to this server.
5649
5650 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5651 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5652 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005653 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005654 a single "listen" section.
5655
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005656 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5657 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5658 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5659
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005660 Example :
5661 listen tse-farm
5662 bind :3389
5663 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5664 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5665 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5666 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5667 persist rdp-cookie
5668 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005669 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005670 balance rdp-cookie
5671 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5672 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5673
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005674 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5675 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005676
5677
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005678rate-limit sessions <rate>
5679 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5681 yes | yes | yes | no
5682 Arguments :
5683 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5684 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5685
5686 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5687 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5688 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5689 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5690 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5691 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5692
5693 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5694 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5695 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5696 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5697
5698 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5699 listen smtp
5700 mode tcp
5701 bind :25
5702 rate-limit sessions 10
5703 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5704
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005705 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5706 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5707 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005708
5709 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5710
5711
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005712redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5713redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5714redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005715 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5717 no | yes | yes | yes
5718
5719 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005720 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005721
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005722 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005723 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005724 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5725 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5726 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005727
5728 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5729 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5730 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5731 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5732 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005733 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5734 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5735 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5736 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005737
5738 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5739 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5740 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5741 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5742 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5743 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005744 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005745 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005746 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5747 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5748 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005749
5750 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005751 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5752 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5753 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5754 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5755 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5756 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5757 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5758 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005759
5760 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5761 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5762
5763 - "drop-query"
5764 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5765 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5766 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5767 with a location-type redirect.
5768
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005769 - "append-slash"
5770 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5771 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5772 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5773 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5774
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005775 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5776 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5777 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5778 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5779 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5780 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5781 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5782
5783 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5784 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5785 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5786 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5787 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5788 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5789 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005790
5791 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5792 acl clear dst_port 80
5793 acl secure dst_port 8080
5794 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005795 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005796 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005797 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5798
5799 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005800 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5801 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5802 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005803 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005804
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005805 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5806 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5807 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5808
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005809 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005810 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005811
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005812 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5813 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5814 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5815
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005816 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005817
5818
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005819redisp (deprecated)
5820redispatch (deprecated)
5821 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5822 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5823 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005824 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005825
5826 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5827 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5828 be able to access the service anymore.
5829
5830 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5831 redistribute them to a working server.
5832
5833 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5834 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5835 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005836
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005837 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5838 "option redispatch" instead.
5839
5840 See also : "option redispatch"
5841
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005842
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005843reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005844 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5846 no | yes | yes | yes
5847 Arguments :
5848 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5849 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005850 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005851
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005852 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5853 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5854
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005855 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5856 the last header of an HTTP request.
5857
5858 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5859 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5860 responses.
5861
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005862 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5863 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5864 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5865
5866 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5867 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005868
5869
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005870reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5871reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005872 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5874 no | yes | yes | yes
5875 Arguments :
5876 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5877 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5878 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5879 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5880 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5881 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5882 ignores case.
5883
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005884 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5885 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5886
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005887 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5888 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5889 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5890 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005891 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005892
5893 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5894 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5895
5896 Example :
5897 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5898 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5899 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5900
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005901 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5902 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005903
5904
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005905reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5906reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005907 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5909 no | yes | yes | yes
5910 Arguments :
5911 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5912 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5913 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5914 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5915 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5916 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5917
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005918 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5919 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5920
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005921 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5922 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5923 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5924 next servers.
5925
5926 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5927 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5928 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5929
5930 Example :
5931 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5932 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5933 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5934
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005935 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5936 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005937
5938
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005939reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5940reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005941 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5943 no | yes | yes | yes
5944 Arguments :
5945 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5946 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5947 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5948 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5949 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5950 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5951 case.
5952
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005953 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5954 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5955
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005956 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5957 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5958 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5959 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005960 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005961
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005962 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005963 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005964 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005965
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005966 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5967 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5968
5969 Example :
5970 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5971 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5972 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5973
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005974 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5975 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005976
5977
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005978reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5979reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005980 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5982 no | yes | yes | yes
5983 Arguments :
5984 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5985 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5986 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5987 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5988 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5989 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5990 case.
5991
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005992 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5993 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5994
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005995 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5996 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5997 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5998 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5999
6000 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6001 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6002
6003 Example :
6004 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
6005 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
6006 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6007 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6008
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006009 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
6010 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006011
6012
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006013reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6014reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006015 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
6016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6017 no | yes | yes | yes
6018 Arguments :
6019 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6020 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6021 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6022 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6023 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
6024 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
6025
6026 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6027 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6028 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6029 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006030 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006031
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006032 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6033 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6034
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006035 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
6036 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
6037 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
6038
6039 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6040 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6041 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6042 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
6043 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6044
6045 Example :
6046 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006047 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006048 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
6049 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
6050
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04006051 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
6052 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006053
6054
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006055reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6056reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006057 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
6058 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6059 no | yes | yes | yes
6060 Arguments :
6061 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6062 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6063 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6064 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6065 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6066 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
6067 ignores case.
6068
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006069 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6070 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6071
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006072 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6073 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006074 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
6075 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
6076 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006077 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
6078 not set.
6079
6080 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
6081 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
6082 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
6083 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
6084 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
6085
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006086 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006087 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
6088 # block all others.
6089 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
6090 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
6091
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006092 # block bad guys
6093 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
6094 reqitarpit . if badguys
6095
6096 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
6097 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006098
6099
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02006100retries <value>
6101 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
6102 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6103 yes | no | yes | yes
6104 Arguments :
6105 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
6106 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
6107 default value is 3.
6108
6109 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
6110 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
6111 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
6112
6113 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
6114 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
6115
6116 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
6117 server even if a cookie references a different server.
6118
6119 See also : "option redispatch"
6120
6121
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006122rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006123 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
6124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6125 no | yes | yes | yes
6126 Arguments :
6127 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6128 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006129 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006130
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006131 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6132 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6133
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006134 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6135 the last header of an HTTP response.
6136
6137 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6138 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6139 responses.
6140
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006141 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
6142 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006143
6144
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006145rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6146rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006147 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
6148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6149 no | yes | yes | yes
6150 Arguments :
6151 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6152 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6153 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6154 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6155 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6156 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
6157 ignores case.
6158
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006159 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6160 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6161
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006162 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
6163 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006164 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006165 client.
6166
6167 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6168 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6169 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6170
6171 Example :
6172 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02006173 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006174
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006175 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
6176 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006177
6178
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006179rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6180rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006181 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
6182 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6183 no | yes | yes | yes
6184 Arguments :
6185 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6186 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6187 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6188 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6189 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6190 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
6191 ignores case.
6192
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006193 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6194 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6195
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006196 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6197 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
6198 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
6199 case-sensitive.
6200
6201 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006202 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
6203 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
6204 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006205
6206 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6207 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
6208
6209 Example :
6210 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
6211 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
6212
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006213 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
6214 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006215
6216
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006217rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6218rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006219 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
6220 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6221 no | yes | yes | yes
6222 Arguments :
6223 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6224 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6225 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6226 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6227 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6228 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
6229 ignores case.
6230
6231 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6232 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6233 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6234 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006235 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006236
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006237 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6238 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6239
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006240 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
6241 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
6242 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
6243
6244 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6245 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6246 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6247 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
6248 are not case-sensitive.
6249
6250 Example :
6251 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
6252 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
6253
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006254 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
6255 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006256
6257
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006258server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006259 Declare a server in a backend
6260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6261 no | no | yes | yes
6262 Arguments :
6263 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02006264 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006265 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006266
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006267 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
6268 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
6269 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
6270 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02006271 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
6272 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
6273 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
6274 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
6275 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006276 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
6277 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
6278 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
6279 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
6280 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6281 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6282 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006283 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006284 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
6285 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
6286 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
6287 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006288
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006289 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006290 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
6291 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
6292 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
6293 adding this value to the client's port.
6294
6295 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
6296 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006297 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006298
6299 Examples :
6300 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
6301 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006302 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006303 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
6304 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
6305 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006306
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006307 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
6308 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006309
6310
6311source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006312source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006313source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006314 Set the source address for outgoing connections
6315 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6316 yes | no | yes | yes
6317 Arguments :
6318 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
6319 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006320
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006321 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006322 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
6323 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
6324 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
6325 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
6326 supported prefixes are :
6327 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6328 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6329 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006330 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006331 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
6332 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
6333 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
6334 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006335
6336 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
6337 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006338 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
6339 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
6340 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006341
6342 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
6343 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
6344 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
6345 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
6346 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
6347 <addr>.
6348
6349 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
6350 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
6351 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
6352 port.
6353
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006354 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
6355 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
6356 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
6357 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01006358 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006359 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
6360 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
6361 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
6362 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
6363 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
6364 HTTP header.
6365
6366 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
6367 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006368 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006369 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
6370 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
6371 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
6372 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
6373 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
6374 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
6375 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
6376
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006377 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
6378 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
6379 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
6380 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
6381 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
6382 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
6383
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006384 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
6385 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
6386 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
6387 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
6388
6389 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
6390 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
6391 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
6392 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
6393 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
6394 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
6395
6396 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
6397 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
6398 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
6399 there are two methods :
6400
6401 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
6402 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
6403 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
6404 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
6405 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
6406 of the client ranges may be used.
6407
6408 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
6409 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
6410 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
6411 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
6412 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
6413 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
6414 same session.
6415
6416 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
6417 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
6418 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
6419 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
6420 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
6421 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
6422
6423 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
6424 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
6425 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006426 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006427
6428 Examples :
6429 backend private
6430 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
6431 source 192.168.1.200
6432
6433 backend transparent_ssl1
6434 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
6435 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6436
6437 backend transparent_ssl2
6438 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
6439 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
6440 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
6441
6442 backend transparent_ssl3
6443 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
6444 # is more conntrack-friendly.
6445 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6446
6447 backend transparent_smtp
6448 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
6449 # with Tproxy version 4.
6450 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
6451
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006452 backend transparent_http
6453 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
6454 # proxy.
6455 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
6456
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006457 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006458 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
6459
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006460
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006461srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6462 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6463 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6464 yes | no | yes | yes
6465 Arguments :
6466 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6467 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6468 as explained at the top of this document.
6469
6470 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6471 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6472 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6473 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6474 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6475 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6476 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6477
6478 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6479 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6480 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6481 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6482 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006483 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006484 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006485 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006486
6487 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6488 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6489 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6490 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6491 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6492 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6493
6494 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
6495 Please use "timeout server" instead.
6496
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006497 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
6498 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006499
6500
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006501stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
6502 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
6503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006504 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006505
6506 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
6507 matched.
6508
6509 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
6510 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
6511
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006512 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6513 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6514 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6515
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01006516 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
6517 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6518 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6519 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006520
6521 Example :
6522 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6523 backend stats_localhost
6524 stats enable
6525 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6526
6527 Example :
6528 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6529 backend stats_auth
6530 stats enable
6531 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6532 stats admin if TRUE
6533
6534 Example :
6535 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6536 userlist stats-auth
6537 group admin users admin
6538 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6539 group readonly users haproxy
6540 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6541
6542 backend stats_auth
6543 stats enable
6544 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6545 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6546 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6547 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6548
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006549 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6550 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6551 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006552
6553
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006554stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6555 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6556 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006557 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006558 Arguments :
6559 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6560
6561 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6562
6563 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6564 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6565 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6566 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6567 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6568 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6569
6570 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6571 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6572 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006573 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006574
6575 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6576 report using "stats scope".
6577
6578 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6579 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6580 unobvious parameters.
6581
6582 Example :
6583 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6584 backend public_www
6585 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6586 stats enable
6587 stats hide-version
6588 stats scope .
6589 stats uri /admin?stats
6590 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6591 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6592 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6593
6594 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6595 backend private_monitoring
6596 stats enable
6597 stats uri /admin?stats
6598 stats refresh 5s
6599
6600 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6601
6602
6603stats enable
6604 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006606 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006607 Arguments : none
6608
6609 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6610 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6611 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6612 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6613 - stats auth : no authentication
6614 - stats scope : no restriction
6615
6616 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6617 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6618 unobvious parameters.
6619
6620 Example :
6621 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6622 backend public_www
6623 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6624 stats enable
6625 stats hide-version
6626 stats scope .
6627 stats uri /admin?stats
6628 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6629 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6630 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6631
6632 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6633 backend private_monitoring
6634 stats enable
6635 stats uri /admin?stats
6636 stats refresh 5s
6637
6638 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6639
6640
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006641stats hide-version
6642 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006644 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006645 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006646
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006647 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6648 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6649 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6650 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6651 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6652 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006653
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006654 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6655 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6656 unobvious parameters.
6657
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006658 Example :
6659 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6660 backend public_www
6661 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006662 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006663 stats hide-version
6664 stats scope .
6665 stats uri /admin?stats
6666 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6667 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6668 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006669
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006670 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6671 backend private_monitoring
6672 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006673 stats uri /admin?stats
6674 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006675
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006676 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006677
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006678
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006679stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6680 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6681 Access control for statistics
6682
6683 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6684 no | no | yes | yes
6685
6686 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6687 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6688 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6689 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6690 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6691 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6692
6693 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6694 instance.
6695
6696 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6697 about ACL usage.
6698
6699
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006700stats realm <realm>
6701 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006703 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006704 Arguments :
6705 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6706 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6707 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6708
6709 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6710 using a backslash ('\').
6711
6712 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6713 only related to authentication.
6714
6715 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6716 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6717 unobvious parameters.
6718
6719 Example :
6720 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6721 backend public_www
6722 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6723 stats enable
6724 stats hide-version
6725 stats scope .
6726 stats uri /admin?stats
6727 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6728 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6729 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6730
6731 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6732 backend private_monitoring
6733 stats enable
6734 stats uri /admin?stats
6735 stats refresh 5s
6736
6737 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6738
6739
6740stats refresh <delay>
6741 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006743 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006744 Arguments :
6745 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6746 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6747 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6748 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6749 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6750 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6751
6752 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6753 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6754 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6755 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6756
6757 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6758 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6759 unobvious parameters.
6760
6761 Example :
6762 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6763 backend public_www
6764 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6765 stats enable
6766 stats hide-version
6767 stats scope .
6768 stats uri /admin?stats
6769 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6770 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6771 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6772
6773 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6774 backend private_monitoring
6775 stats enable
6776 stats uri /admin?stats
6777 stats refresh 5s
6778
6779 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6780
6781
6782stats scope { <name> | "." }
6783 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006785 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006786 Arguments :
6787 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6788 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6789 section in which the statement appears.
6790
6791 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6792 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6793 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6794 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6795 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6796 exists.
6797
6798 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6799 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6800 unobvious parameters.
6801
6802 Example :
6803 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6804 backend public_www
6805 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6806 stats enable
6807 stats hide-version
6808 stats scope .
6809 stats uri /admin?stats
6810 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6811 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6812 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6813
6814 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6815 backend private_monitoring
6816 stats enable
6817 stats uri /admin?stats
6818 stats refresh 5s
6819
6820 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6821
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006822
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006823stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006824 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006826 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006827
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006828 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006829 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6830
6831 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6832 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6833
6834 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6835 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006836 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006837
6838 Example :
6839 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6840 backend private_monitoring
6841 stats enable
6842 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6843 stats uri /admin?stats
6844 stats refresh 5s
6845
6846 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6847 global section.
6848
6849
6850stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006851 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
6852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6853 yes | yes | yes | yes
6854 Arguments : none
6855
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006856 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006857 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6858 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6859 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6860 - IP (socket, server)
6861 - cookie (backend, server)
6862
6863 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6864 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006865 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006866
6867 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6868
6869
6870stats show-node [ <name> ]
6871 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6872 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006873 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006874 Arguments:
6875 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6876 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6877
6878 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6879 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006880 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006881
6882 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6883 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6884 unobvious parameters.
6885
6886 Example:
6887 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6888 backend private_monitoring
6889 stats enable
6890 stats show-node Europe-1
6891 stats uri /admin?stats
6892 stats refresh 5s
6893
6894 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6895 section.
6896
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006897
6898stats uri <prefix>
6899 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6900 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006901 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006902 Arguments :
6903 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6904 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6905 query string.
6906
6907 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6908 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6909 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6910 possible to reach it in the application.
6911
6912 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006913 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006914 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6915 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6916 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6917 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6918
6919 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6920 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6921 an address or a port to statistics only.
6922
6923 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6924 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6925 unobvious parameters.
6926
6927 Example :
6928 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6929 backend public_www
6930 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6931 stats enable
6932 stats hide-version
6933 stats scope .
6934 stats uri /admin?stats
6935 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6936 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6937 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6938
6939 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6940 backend private_monitoring
6941 stats enable
6942 stats uri /admin?stats
6943 stats refresh 5s
6944
6945 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6946
6947
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006948stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6949 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006951 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006952
6953 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006954 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006955 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6956 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6957 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6958
6959 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6960 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6961 the "stick-table" statement.
6962
6963 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6964 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6965 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6966 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6967 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6968
6969 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6970 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6971 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6972 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6973 transformation rules.
6974
6975 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6976 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6977 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6978 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6979 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6980 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6981 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6982
6983 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6984 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6985 ACL based conditions.
6986
6987 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6988 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6989 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6990 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6991
6992 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6993 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6994 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6995 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6996
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006997 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6998 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6999 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7000
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007001 Example :
7002 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7003 # last 30 minutes
7004 backend pop
7005 mode tcp
7006 balance roundrobin
7007 stick store-request src
7008 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7009 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7010 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7011
7012 backend smtp
7013 mode tcp
7014 balance roundrobin
7015 stick match src table pop
7016 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7017 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7018
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007019 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007020 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007021
7022
7023stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7024 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
7025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7026 no | no | yes | yes
7027
7028 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
7029 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
7030 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
7031 for writing more maintainable configurations.
7032
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007033 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7034 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7035 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7036
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007037 Examples :
7038 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01007039 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007040
7041 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
7042 stick match src table pop if !localhost
7043 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
7044
7045
7046 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
7047 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
7048 backend http
7049 mode http
7050 balance roundrobin
7051 stick on src table https
7052 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
7053 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
7054 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
7055
7056 backend https
7057 mode tcp
7058 balance roundrobin
7059 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7060 stick on src
7061 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7062 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7063
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007064 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007065
7066
7067stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7068 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7070 no | no | yes | yes
7071
7072 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007073 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007074 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7075 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7076 server is selected.
7077
7078 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7079 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7080 the "stick-table" statement.
7081
7082 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7083 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7084 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
7085 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
7086 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
7087 address.
7088
7089 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7090 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
7091 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
7092 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
7093 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
7094 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
7095 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
7096 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
7097 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
7098 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
7099
7100 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7101 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7102 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7103 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7104 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7105 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7106 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7107
7108 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
7109 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7110 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
7111 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7112
7113 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
7114 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7115 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7116 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7117 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7118 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007119 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
7120 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7121 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7122 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7123 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7124 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007125
7126 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
7127 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
7128 the request.
7129
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007130 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7131 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7132 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7133
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007134 Example :
7135 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7136 # last 30 minutes
7137 backend pop
7138 mode tcp
7139 balance roundrobin
7140 stick store-request src
7141 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7142 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7143 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7144
7145 backend smtp
7146 mode tcp
7147 balance roundrobin
7148 stick match src table pop
7149 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7150 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7151
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007152 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007153 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007154
7155
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007156stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007157 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
7158 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08007159 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007161 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007162
7163 Arguments :
7164 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
7165 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
7166 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7167 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7168
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01007169 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
7170 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
7171 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7172 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7173
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007174 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
7175 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
7176 instance.
7177
7178 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
7179 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
7180 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
7181 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
7182 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
7183 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007184 to 32 characters.
7185
7186 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
7187 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
7188 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007189 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007190 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
7191 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007192
7193 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007194 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
7195 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007196 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
7197 increase.
7198
7199 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007200 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
7201 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
7202 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007203
7204 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
7205 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
7206 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
7207 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
7208 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
7209 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
7210 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
7211 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
7212 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
7213 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
7214 parameter (see below).
7215
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007216 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
7217 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
7218 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
7219 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
7220 soft restart.
7221
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007222 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
7223
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007224 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
7225 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
7226 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
7227 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
7228 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007229 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007230 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
7231 if not expiration delay is specified.
7232
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007233 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
7234 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
7235 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
7236 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007237 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
7238 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
7239 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
7240 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
7241 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
7242 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
7243 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
7244 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
7245 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
7246 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
7247 types and their arguments.
7248
7249 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
7250 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
7251 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
7252 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
7253
7254 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
7255 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
7256 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
7257 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
7258
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02007259 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
7260 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
7261 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
7262 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
7263 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
7264 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
7265
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007266 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7267 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
7268 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
7269 they were received.
7270
7271 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7272 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
7273 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
7274 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
7275 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
7276
7277 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7278 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7279 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7280 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
7281 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7282
7283 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7284 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
7285 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
7286
7287 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7288 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7289 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7290 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
7291 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7292
7293 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7294 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
7295 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
7296 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
7297 the client side.
7298
7299 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7300 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7301 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7302 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
7303 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
7304 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
7305 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
7306
7307 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7308 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
7309 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
7310 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
7311 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
7312 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
7313 (eg: vulnerability scan).
7314
7315 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7316 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7317 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7318 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
7319 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
7320 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7321
7322 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7323 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
7324 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
7325 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
7326
7327 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7328 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7329 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7330 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7331 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7332 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
7333 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
7334 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
7335 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
7336 recommended for better fairness.
7337
7338 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7339 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
7340 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
7341 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
7342
7343 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
7344 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7345 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7346 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7347 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7348 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
7349 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
7350 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
7351 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
7352 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007353
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007354 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
7355 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007356 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
7357 reference it.
7358
7359 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
7360 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
7361 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
7362 as an exclusive stickiness.
7363
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007364 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
7365 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
7366 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
7367 something that can be ignored.
7368
7369 Example:
7370 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
7371 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
7372 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
7373 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
7374
7375 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01007376 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007377
7378
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007379stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7380 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7381 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7382 no | no | yes | yes
7383
7384 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007385 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007386 describes what elements of the response or connection will
7387 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7388 server is selected.
7389
7390 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7391 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7392 the "stick-table" statement.
7393
7394 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7395 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7396 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
7397 when the response is a SSL server hello.
7398
7399 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7400 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
7401 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
7402 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
7403 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
7404 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007405 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007406 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
7407 rules.
7408
7409 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7410 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7411 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7412 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7413 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7414 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7415 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7416
7417 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
7418 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7419 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
7420 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7421
7422 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
7423 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7424 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7425 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7426 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7427 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007428 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
7429 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7430 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7431 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7432 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7433 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
7434 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
7435 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
7436 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007437
7438 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
7439
7440 Example :
7441 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
7442 backend https
7443 mode tcp
7444 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007445 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007446 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007447
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007448 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
7449 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
7450
7451 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
7452 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7453 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
7454
7455 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
7456 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007457
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007458 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
7459 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
7460 # at offset 44.
7461
7462 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
7463 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
7464
7465 # Learn on response if server hello.
7466 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007467
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007468 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7469 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7470
7471 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
7472 extraction.
7473
7474
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02007475tcp-check connect [params*]
7476 Opens a new connection
7477 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7478 no | no | yes | yes
7479
7480 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
7481 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
7482 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
7483
7484 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
7485 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
7486 of the sequence.
7487
7488 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
7489 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
7490 do.
7491
7492 Parameters :
7493 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
7494 use the TCP connection.
7495
7496 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
7497 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
7498 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
7499
7500 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
7501
7502 ssl opens a ciphered connection
7503
7504 Examples:
7505 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
7506 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
7507 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
7508 option tcp-check
7509 tcp-check connect
7510 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7511 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7512 tcp-check send \r\n
7513 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7514 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
7515 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7516 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7517 tcp-check send \r\n
7518 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7519 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7520
7521 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7522 option tcp-check
7523 tcp-check connect port 110
7524 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7525 tcp-check connect port 143
7526 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7527 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7528
7529 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7530
7531
7532tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7533 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7534 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7535 no | no | yes | yes
7536
7537 Arguments :
7538 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7539 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7540 binary.
7541 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7542 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7543 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7544
7545 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7546 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7547 with the usual backslash ('\').
7548 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7549 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7550 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7551 used upper or lower case.
7552
7553
7554 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7555
7556 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7557 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7558 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7559 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7560 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7561 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7562 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7563 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7564
7565 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7566 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7567 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7568 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7569 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7570 expression.
7571
7572 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7573 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7574 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7575 this exact hexadecimal string.
7576 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7577
7578 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7579 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7580 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7581 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7582 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7583 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7584 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7585 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7586 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7587 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7588 the null character.
7589
7590 Examples :
7591 # perform a POP check
7592 option tcp-check
7593 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7594
7595 # perform an IMAP check
7596 option tcp-check
7597 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7598
7599 # look for the redis master server
7600 option tcp-check
7601 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7602 tcp-check expect +PONG
7603 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7604 tcp-check expect string role:master
7605 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7606 tcp-check expect string +OK
7607
7608
7609 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7610 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7611
7612
7613tcp-check send <data>
7614 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7615 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7616 no | no | yes | yes
7617
7618 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7619 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7620
7621 Examples :
7622 # look for the redis master server
7623 option tcp-check
7624 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7625 tcp-check expect string role:master
7626
7627 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7628 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
7629
7630
7631tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
7632 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
7633 tcp health check
7634 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7635 no | no | yes | yes
7636
7637 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7638 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7639 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
7640 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
7641 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
7642 hexadecimal string.
7643 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
7644
7645 Examples :
7646 # redis check in binary
7647 option tcp-check
7648 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
7649 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
7650
7651
7652 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7653 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
7654
7655
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007656tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7657 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7659 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007660 Arguments :
7661 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007662 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7663 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007664
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007665 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007666
7667 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
7668 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007669 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
7670 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
7671 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
7672 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
7673 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
7674 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007675
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007676 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
7677 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
7678 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
7679 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007680
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007681 Five types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007682 - accept :
7683 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7684 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7685 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007686
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007687 - reject :
7688 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7689 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7690 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
7691 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
7692 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
7693 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
7694 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
7695 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
7696 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
7697 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
7698 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7699 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007700
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007701 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7702 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7703 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7704 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7705 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7706 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7707 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7708 hosts.
7709
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007710 - capture <sample> len <length> :
7711 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
7712 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
7713 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
7714 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
7715 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
7716 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
7717 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
7718 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
7719 session life. Since it applies to Please check section 7.3 (Fetching
7720 samples) and "capture request header" for more information.
7721
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007722 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007723 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007724 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007725 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007726 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7727 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007728 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007729 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7730 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7731 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7732 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7733 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007734
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007735 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007736 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007737 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007738 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7739 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7740 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7741 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007742
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007743 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7744 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7745 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7746 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007747
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007748 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7749 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7750 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7751 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7752 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007753 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7754 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7755 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7756 layer7 information is extracted.
7757
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007758 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7759 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7760 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7761 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7762 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007763
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007764 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7765 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7766 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007767
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007768 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7769 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7770 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007771
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007772 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007773 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007774 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007775
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007776 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7777 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7778 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007779
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007780 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007781 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7782 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007783
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007784 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7785
7786 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7787
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007788 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7789
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007790 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007791
7792
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007793tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7794 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007795 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007796 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007797 Arguments :
7798 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007799 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007800 "track-sc2" and "capture". See "tcp-request connection" above
7801 for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007802
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007803 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007804
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007805 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7806 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7807 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7808 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7809 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007810
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007811 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7812 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7813 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7814 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007815 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7816 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7817 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7818 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7819 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7820 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007821 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007822 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007823
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007824 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7825 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7826 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7827 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007828
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007829 Four types of actions are supported :
7830 - accept : the request is accepted
7831 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
7832 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007833 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007834
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007835 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7836 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007837
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007838 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7839 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7840 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7841 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7842 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7843 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007844
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007845 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007846 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7847 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007848
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007849 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007850 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7851 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7852 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7853 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007854 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7855 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
7856 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007857
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007858 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007859 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
7860 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
7861 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007862
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007863 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007864 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7865 # and reject everything else.
7866 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7867 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007868 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007869 tcp-request content reject
7870
7871 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007872 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7873 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7874 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007875 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007876
7877 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7878 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7879 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007880 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007881 tcp-request content reject
7882
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007883 Example:
7884 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7885 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007886 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007887
7888 Example:
7889 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7890 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007891 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007892
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007893 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7894 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7895
7896 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007897 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007898 # protecting all our sites
7899 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007900 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7901 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007902 ...
7903 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7904
7905 backend http_dynamic
7906 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007907 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007908 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007909 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7910 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7911 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007912 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007913
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007914 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007915
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007916 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007917
7918
7919tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7920 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007922 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007923 Arguments :
7924 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7925 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7926 as explained at the top of this document.
7927
7928 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7929 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7930 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7931 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7932 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7933
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007934 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7935 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7936 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7937 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7938
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007939 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7940 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007941 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007942 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007943 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7944 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7945 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7946 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007947
7948 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7949 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7950 it pass through unaffected.
7951
7952 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7953 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7954 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007955 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007956 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7957 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007958 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7959 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7960 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007961
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007962 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007963 "timeout client".
7964
7965
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007966tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7967 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7969 no | no | yes | yes
7970 Arguments :
7971 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007972 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007973
7974 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7975
7976 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7977 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7978 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007979 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7980 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007981
7982 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7983
7984 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7985 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7986 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7987 inserted.
7988
7989 Two types of actions are supported :
7990 - accept :
7991 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7992 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7993 the rules evaluation.
7994
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007995 - close :
7996 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7997 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7998 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7999 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
8000 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
8001 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008002 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008003 protocols.
8004
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008005 - reject :
8006 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8007 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008008 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008009
8010 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8011 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8012 for changing the default action to a reject.
8013
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008014 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
8015 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
8016 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
8017 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008018 period.
8019
8020 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8021
8022 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
8023
8024
8025tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
8026 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
8027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8028 no | no | yes | yes
8029 Arguments :
8030 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8031 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8032 as explained at the top of this document.
8033
8034 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
8035
8036
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008037timeout check <timeout>
8038 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
8039 established.
8040
8041 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8042 yes | no | yes | yes
8043 Arguments:
8044 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8045 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8046 as explained at the top of this document.
8047
8048 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
8049 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
8050 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
8051 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01008052 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
8053 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
8054 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008055
8056 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
8057 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
8058
8059 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
8060 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008061 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008062
8063 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8064 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8065 forget about it.
8066
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008067 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
8068 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008069
8070
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008071timeout client <timeout>
8072timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8073 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
8074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8075 yes | yes | yes | no
8076 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008077 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008078 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8079 as explained at the top of this document.
8080
8081 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
8082 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8083 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
8084 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
8085 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
8086 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
8087 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
8088 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008089 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008090 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008091 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
8092 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008093 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
8094 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008095
8096 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
8097 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8098 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8099 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8100 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8101 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8102
8103 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
8104 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
8105 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8106
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008107 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008108
8109
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008110timeout client-fin <timeout>
8111 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
8112 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8113 yes | yes | yes | no
8114 Arguments :
8115 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8116 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8117 as explained at the top of this document.
8118
8119 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
8120 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8121 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8122 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8123 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
8124 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8125 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8126 down in one direction.
8127
8128 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
8129 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8130 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
8131
8132 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
8133
8134
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008135timeout connect <timeout>
8136timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8137 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
8138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8139 yes | no | yes | yes
8140 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008141 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008142 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8143 as explained at the top of this document.
8144
8145 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008146 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008147 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008148 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008149 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
8150 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008151
8152 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8153 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8154 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8155 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8156 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
8157 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8158
8159 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
8160 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
8161 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8162
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008163 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
8164 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008165
8166
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008167timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
8168 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
8169 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8170 yes | yes | yes | yes
8171 Arguments :
8172 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8173 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8174 as explained at the top of this document.
8175
8176 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
8177 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
8178 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
8179 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
8180 once the request has started to present itself.
8181
8182 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
8183 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
8184 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
8185 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
8186 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
8187
8188 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
8189 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
8190 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
8191 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
8192
8193 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
8194 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
8195 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
8196 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
8197 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02008198 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008199
8200 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
8201 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
8202 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
8203 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
8204
8205 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
8206
8207
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008208timeout http-request <timeout>
8209 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
8210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008211 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008212 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008213 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008214 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8215 as explained at the top of this document.
8216
8217 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
8218 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
8219 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
8220 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
8221 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
8222 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
8223 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02008224 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
8225 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
8226 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
8227 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
8228 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
8229 code using "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See more details in the explanations of
8230 the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008231
8232 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
8233 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008234 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
8235 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008236
8237 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
8238 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
8239 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
8240 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
8241 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
8242
8243 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008244 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
8245 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
8246 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008247
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02008248 See also : "errorfile", "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008249
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008250
8251timeout queue <timeout>
8252 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
8253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8254 yes | no | yes | yes
8255 Arguments :
8256 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8257 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8258 as explained at the top of this document.
8259
8260 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
8261 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
8262 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
8263 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
8264 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
8265
8266 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
8267 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
8268 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
8269 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
8270
8271 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8272
8273
8274timeout server <timeout>
8275timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8276 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8278 yes | no | yes | yes
8279 Arguments :
8280 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8281 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8282 as explained at the top of this document.
8283
8284 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8285 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8286 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8287 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8288 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8289 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8290 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8291
8292 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8293 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8294 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8295 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8296 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008297 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008298 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008299 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
8300 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
8301 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
8302 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008303
8304 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8305 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8306 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8307 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8308 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8309 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8310
8311 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
8312 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
8313 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8314
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008315 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008316
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008317
8318timeout server-fin <timeout>
8319 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
8320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8321 yes | no | yes | yes
8322 Arguments :
8323 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8324 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8325 as explained at the top of this document.
8326
8327 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8328 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8329 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8330 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8331 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
8332 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8333 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8334 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
8335 situations, it should not be needed.
8336
8337 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8338 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8339 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
8340
8341 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
8342
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008343
8344timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008345 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8347 yes | yes | yes | yes
8348 Arguments :
8349 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
8350 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8351 as explained at the top of this document.
8352
8353 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
8354 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
8355 defines how long it will be maintained open.
8356
8357 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8358 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8359 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
8360 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008361 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008362
8363 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8364
8365
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008366timeout tunnel <timeout>
8367 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
8368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8369 yes | no | yes | yes
8370 Arguments :
8371 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8372 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8373 as explained at the top of this document.
8374
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008375 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008376 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
8377 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
8378 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
8379 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
8380 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
8381 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
8382 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
8383 specified.
8384
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008385 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
8386 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
8387 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
8388 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
8389 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
8390 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
8391 state.
8392
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008393 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8394 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8395 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
8396 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
8397 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
8398
8399 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8400 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8401 forget about it.
8402
8403 Example :
8404 defaults http
8405 option http-server-close
8406 timeout connect 5s
8407 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008408 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008409 timeout server 30s
8410 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
8411
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008412 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008413
8414
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008415transparent (deprecated)
8416 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008418 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008419 Arguments : none
8420
8421 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
8422 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8423 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8424 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8425 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8426 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8427 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8428 appropriate server.
8429
8430 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
8431
8432 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8433 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8434
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008435 See also: "option transparent"
8436
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008437unique-id-format <string>
8438 Generate a unique ID for each request.
8439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8440 yes | yes | yes | no
8441 Arguments :
8442 <string> is a log-format string.
8443
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008444 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
8445 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
8446 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
8447 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008448
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008449 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
8450 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
8451 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
8452 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
8453 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
8454 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
8455 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
8456 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008457
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008458 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
8459 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008460
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008461 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008462
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008463 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008464
8465 will generate:
8466
8467 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8468
8469 See also: "unique-id-header"
8470
8471unique-id-header <name>
8472 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
8473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8474 yes | yes | yes | no
8475 Arguments :
8476 <name> is the name of the header.
8477
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008478 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
8479 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008480
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008481 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008482
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008483 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008484 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
8485
8486 will generate:
8487
8488 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8489
8490 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008491
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008492use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008493 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8495 no | yes | yes | no
8496 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008497 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
8498 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008499
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008500 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
8501 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008502
8503 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
8504 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
8505 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008506 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
8507 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
8508 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
8509 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008510
8511 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
8512 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
8513 assign the backend.
8514
8515 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
8516 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8517 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
8518 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
8519 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
8520 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
8521
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008522 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008523 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008524 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
8525 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
8526 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
8527
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008528 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
8529 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
8530 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
8531 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
8532 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
8533 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
8534 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
8535 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
8536 cannot be forced from the request.
8537
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008538 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008539 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
8540 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
8541
8542 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
8543 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008544
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008545
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008546use-server <server> if <condition>
8547use-server <server> unless <condition>
8548 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
8549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8550 no | no | yes | yes
8551 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008552 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008553
8554 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
8555
8556 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
8557 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
8558 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
8559
8560 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
8561 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
8562 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
8563 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
8564 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
8565 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
8566 matches will assign the server.
8567
8568 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
8569 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
8570 with the next rules until one matches.
8571
8572 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
8573 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8574 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
8575 according to other persistence mechanisms.
8576
8577 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
8578 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
8579 stripped.
8580
8581 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
8582 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
8583 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
8584 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
8585
8586 Example :
8587 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
8588 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
8589 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
8590 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
8591 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
8592 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
8593 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
8594 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
8595 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
8596
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008597 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008598
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008599
86005. Bind and Server options
8601--------------------------
8602
8603The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
8604depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
8605settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
8606written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
8607described in this section.
8608
8609
86105.1. Bind options
8611-----------------
8612
8613The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
8614as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
8615no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
8616parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
8617while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
8618provided immediately after the setting name.
8619
8620The currently supported settings are the following ones.
8621
8622accept-proxy
8623 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02008624 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
8625 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008626 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
8627 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
8628 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
8629 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
8630 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
8631 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
8632 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008633 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
8634 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008635
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008636alpn <protocols>
8637 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
8638 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
8639 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
8640 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
8641 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
8642 initial NPN extension.
8643
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008644backlog <backlog>
8645 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
8646 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
8647
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008648ecdhe <named curve>
8649 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01008650 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
8651 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008652
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008653ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008654 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8655 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8656 client's certificate.
8657
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008658ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
8659 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8660 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
8661 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
8662 error is ignored.
8663
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008664ciphers <ciphers>
8665 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
8666 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008667 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008668 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
8669 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
8670
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008671crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008672 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8673 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8674 to verify client's certificate.
8675
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008676crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008677 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8678 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
8679 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
8680 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
8681 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
8682 file.
8683
8684 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
8685 are loaded.
8686
8687 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01008688 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
8689 '.issuer' or '.ocsp' (reserved extensions). This directive may be specified
8690 multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
8691 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
8692 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects.
8693 Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the
8694 first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008695 www.sub.example.org).
8696
8697 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
8698 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
8699 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
8700 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01008701 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
8702 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008703
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02008704 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008705
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008706 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
8707 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08008708 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008709 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
8710 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
8711 clients).
8712
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008713 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
8714 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
8715 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
8716 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
8717 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
8718 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
8719 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
8720 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
8721 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
8722 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
8723 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
8724 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
8725 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
8726
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008727crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008728 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
8729 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008730 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008731 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008732
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008733crt-list <file>
8734 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008735 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
8736 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008737
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008738 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008739
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008740 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
8741 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
8742 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
8743 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
8744 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
8745 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
8746 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
8747 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008748
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008749defer-accept
8750 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8751 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
8752 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
8753 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
8754 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
8755 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
8756 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
8757 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
8758 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
8759 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
8760 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
8761
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008762force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008763 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008764 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008765 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
8766 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008767
8768force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008769 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008770 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8771 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008772
8773force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008774 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008775 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8776 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008777
8778force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008779 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008780 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8781 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008782
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008783gid <gid>
8784 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
8785 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8786 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
8787 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
8788 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8789
8790group <group>
8791 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
8792 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
8793 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
8794 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
8795 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8796
8797id <id>
8798 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
8799 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
8800 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
8801 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
8802
8803interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01008804 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8805 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8806 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8807 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8808 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8809 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8810 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008811
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008812level <level>
8813 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
8814 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
8815 sockets. <level> can be one of :
8816 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
8817 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
8818 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
8819 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
8820 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8821 counters).
8822 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8823 all counters).
8824
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008825maxconn <maxconn>
8826 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8827 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8828 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8829 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8830 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8831 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8832 eat all memory.
8833
8834mode <mode>
8835 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8836 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8837 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
8838 UNIX sockets.
8839
8840mss <maxseg>
8841 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
8842 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
8843 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
8844 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
8845 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
8846 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
8847 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
8848 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
8849 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
8850 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
8851 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
8852
8853name <name>
8854 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
8855 page.
8856
8857nice <nice>
8858 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
8859 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
8860 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
8861 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
8862 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
8863 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
8864 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
8865 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
8866 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
8867 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
8868 one for an RDP socket.
8869
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008870no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008871 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008872 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008873 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008874 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
8875 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008876 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008877
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008878no-tls-tickets
8879 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8880 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8881 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008882 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
8883 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008884
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008885no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008886 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008887 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008888 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008889 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8890 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8891 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008892
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008893no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008894 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008895 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008896 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008897 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8898 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8899 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008900
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008901no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008902 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008903 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008904 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008905 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8906 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8907 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008908
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008909npn <protocols>
8910 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
8911 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
8912 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
8913 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008914 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
8915 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008916
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008917process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
8918 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
8919 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
8920 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
8921 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
8922 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
8923 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
8924 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02008925 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
8926 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
8927 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
8928 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
8929 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
8930 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
8931 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008932
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008933ssl
8934 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008935 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008936 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
8937 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
8938 to deciphered contents.
8939
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01008940strict-sni
8941 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
8942 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
8943 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
8944 See the "crt" option for more information.
8945
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +01008946tcp-ut <delay>
8947 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instanciated from this
8948 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
8949 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
8950 receiving an acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
8951 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
8952 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
8953 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
8954 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
8955 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
8956 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
8957 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
8958
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008959tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01008960 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008961 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
8962 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
8963 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
8964 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
8965 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
8966 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
8967 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02008968 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
8969 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
8970 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008971
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +01008972tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
8973 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
8974 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
8975 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
8976 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
8977 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
8978 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
8979 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
8980 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
8981 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
8982 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
8983
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008984transparent
8985 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8986 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
8987 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
8988 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
8989 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
8990 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
8991 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
8992 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
8993 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
8994 so check for support with your vendor.
8995
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008996v4v6
8997 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8998 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
8999 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
9000 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009001 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009002
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01009003v6only
9004 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
9005 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
9006 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009007 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
9008 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01009009
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009010uid <uid>
9011 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
9012 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9013 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
9014 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
9015 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9016
9017user <user>
9018 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
9019 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9020 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
9021 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
9022 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9023
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009024verify [none|optional|required]
9025 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
9026 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
9027 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
9028 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
9029 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009030 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
9031 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
9032 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
9033 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009034
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020090355.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009036------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009037
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009038The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
9039which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
9040arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
9041settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
9042after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
9043Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
9044address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009045
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009046 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009047 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009048
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009049The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009050
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009051addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009052 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
9053 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
9054 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
9055 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
9056 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009057
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009058 Supported in default-server: No
9059
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009060agent-check
9061 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009062 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
9063 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
9064 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
9065 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009066
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009067 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009068 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +02009069 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
9070 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
9071 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009072
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009073 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9074 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009075
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009076 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9077 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
9078 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009079
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009080 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9081 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
9082 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009083
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009084 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
9085 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
9086 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
9087 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
9088 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
9089 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
9090 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009091
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009092 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
9093 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009094
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009095 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
9096 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
9097 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
9098 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
9099 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
9100 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
9101 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
9102 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
9103 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009104
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09009105 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
9106 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009107 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
9108 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
9109 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
9110 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09009111
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009112 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
9113 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009114
9115 Supported in default-server: No
9116
9117agent-inter <delay>
9118 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
9119 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9120
9121 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
9122 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
9123 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
9124 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
9125 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9126 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9127 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9128 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9129 of backends use the same servers.
9130
9131 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
9132
9133 Supported in default-server: Yes
9134
9135agent-port <port>
9136 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
9137
9138 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
9139
9140 Supported in default-server: Yes
9141
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009142backup
9143 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
9144 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
9145 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
9146 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
9147 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
9148 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009149
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009150 Supported in default-server: No
9151
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009152ca-file <cafile>
9153 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9154 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
9155 server's certificate.
9156
9157 Supported in default-server: No
9158
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009159check
9160 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01009161 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
9162 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
9163 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
9164 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
9165 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
9166 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
9167 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09009168 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
9169 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
9170 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009171
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009172 Supported in default-server: No
9173
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009174check-send-proxy
9175 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
9176 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
9177 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
9178 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
9179 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
9180 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
9181 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
9182
9183 Supported in default-server: No
9184
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009185check-ssl
9186 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
9187 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
9188 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
9189 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009190 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009191 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
9192 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
9193 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
9194 See the "ssl" option for more information.
9195
9196 Supported in default-server: No
9197
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009198ciphers <ciphers>
9199 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009200 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009201 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
9202 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
9203 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
9204 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
9205 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
9206 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
9207
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009208 Supported in default-server: No
9209
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009210cookie <value>
9211 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
9212 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
9213 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
9214 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
9215 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
9216 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
9217 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
9218
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009219 Supported in default-server: No
9220
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009221crl-file <crlfile>
9222 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9223 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9224 to verify server's certificate.
9225
9226 Supported in default-server: No
9227
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02009228crt <cert>
9229 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9230 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
9231 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
9232 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
9233 certificate request.
9234
9235 Supported in default-server: No
9236
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02009237disabled
9238 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
9239 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
9240 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
9241 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
9242 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
9243
9244 Supported in default-server: No
9245
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009246error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009247 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
9248 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
9249 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009250
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009251 Supported in default-server: Yes
9252
9253 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009254
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009255fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009256 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
9257 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
9258 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
9259
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009260 Supported in default-server: Yes
9261
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009262force-sslv3
9263 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
9264 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009265 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9266 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009267
9268 Supported in default-server: No
9269
9270force-tlsv10
9271 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009272 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9273 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009274
9275 Supported in default-server: No
9276
9277force-tlsv11
9278 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009279 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9280 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009281
9282 Supported in default-server: No
9283
9284force-tlsv12
9285 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009286 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9287 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009288
9289 Supported in default-server: No
9290
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009291id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02009292 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
9293 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
9294 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009295
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009296 Supported in default-server: No
9297
9298inter <delay>
9299fastinter <delay>
9300downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009301 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
9302 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9303 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
9304 between checks depending on the server state :
9305
9306 Server state | Interval used
9307 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9308 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
9309 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9310 Transitionally UP (going down), |
9311 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9312 or yet unchecked. |
9313 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9314 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9315 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009316
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009317 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
9318 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
9319 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
9320 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009321 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9322 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9323 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9324 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9325 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009326
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009327 Supported in default-server: Yes
9328
9329maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009330 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
9331 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
9332 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
9333 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
9334 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
9335 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
9336 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
9337 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
9338
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009339 Supported in default-server: Yes
9340
9341maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009342 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
9343 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
9344 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
9345 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
9346 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
9347 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
9348 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
9349
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009350 Supported in default-server: Yes
9351
9352minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009353 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
9354 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
9355 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
9356 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
9357 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
9358 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009359 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009360 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009361
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009362 Supported in default-server: Yes
9363
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +01009364no-ssl-reuse
9365 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
9366 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
9367 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
9368 and for paranoid users.
9369
9370 Supported in default-server: No
9371
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009372no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009373 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
9374 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009375 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009376
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009377 Supported in default-server: No
9378
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009379no-tls-tickets
9380 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9381 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9382 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009383 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
9384 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009385
9386 Supported in default-server: No
9387
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009388no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009389 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009390 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9391 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009392 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9393 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9394 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009395
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009396 Supported in default-server: No
9397
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009398no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009399 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009400 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9401 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009402 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9403 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9404 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009405
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009406 Supported in default-server: No
9407
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009408no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009409 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009410 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9411 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009412 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9413 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9414 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009415
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009416 Supported in default-server: No
9417
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09009418non-stick
9419 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
9420 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
9421 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
9422
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009423 Supported in default-server: No
9424
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009425observe <mode>
9426 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
9427 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
9428 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
9429 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
9430 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
9431 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01009432 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009433
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009434 Supported in default-server: No
9435
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009436 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
9437
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009438on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009439 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
9440 Currently, four modes are available:
9441 - fastinter: force fastinter
9442 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
9443 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
9444 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
9445 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
9446
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009447 Supported in default-server: Yes
9448
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009449 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
9450
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009451on-marked-down <action>
9452 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
9453 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009454 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
9455 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
9456 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
9457 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
9458 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
9459 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
9460 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
9461 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009462
9463 Actions are disabled by default
9464
9465 Supported in default-server: Yes
9466
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009467on-marked-up <action>
9468 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
9469 Currently one action is available:
9470 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
9471 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
9472 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
9473 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
9474 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
9475 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
9476 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
9477 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
9478
9479 Actions are disabled by default
9480
9481 Supported in default-server: Yes
9482
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009483port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009484 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
9485 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
9486 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
9487 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
9488 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
9489 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
9490
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009491 Supported in default-server: Yes
9492
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009493redir <prefix>
9494 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
9495 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
9496 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
9497 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
9498 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
9499 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
9500 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
9501 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009502 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009503 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
9504 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
9505 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
9506 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
9507 loop between the client and HAProxy!
9508
9509 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
9510
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009511 Supported in default-server: No
9512
9513rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009514 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
9515 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
9516 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
9517
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009518 Supported in default-server: Yes
9519
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009520send-proxy
9521 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
9522 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
9523 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
9524 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
9525 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
9526 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
9527 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
9528 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
9529 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009530 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
9531 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
9532 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
9533 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
9534 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009535
9536 Supported in default-server: No
9537
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -04009538send-proxy-v2
9539 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
9540 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9541 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9542 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9543 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
9544 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
9545 option of the "bind" keyword.
9546
9547 Supported in default-server: No
9548
9549send-proxy-v2-ssl
9550 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9551 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9552 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9553 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9554 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9555 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
9556 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
9557 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9558
9559 Supported in default-server: No
9560
9561send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
9562 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9563 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9564 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9565 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9566 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9567 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
9568 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
9569 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
9570 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9571
9572 Supported in default-server: No
9573
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009574slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009575 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
9576 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
9577 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
9578 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
9579 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
9580 parameters :
9581
9582 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
9583 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
9584
9585 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
9586 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
9587 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
9588 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
9589
9590 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
9591 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
9592 seen as failed.
9593
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009594 Supported in default-server: Yes
9595
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009596source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009597source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009598source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009599 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
9600 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
9601 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
9602 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
9603
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009604 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
9605 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
9606 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
9607 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
9608 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
9609 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
9610 server.
9611
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009612 Supported in default-server: No
9613
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009614ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009615 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
9616 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
9617 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
9618 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
9619 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
9620 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009621 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009622
9623 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009624
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009625track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +02009626 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
9627 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
9628 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
9629 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009630 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
9631
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009632 Supported in default-server: No
9633
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009634verify [none|required]
9635 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01009636 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
9637 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
9638 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
9639 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009640 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
9641 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
9642 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009643
9644 Supported in default-server: No
9645
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07009646verifyhost <hostname>
9647 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
9648 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
9649 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
9650 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
9651 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
9652 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
9653
9654 Supported in default-server: No
9655
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009656weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009657 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
9658 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
9659 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02009660 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
9661 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
9662 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
9663 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
9664 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
9665 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009666
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009667 Supported in default-server: Yes
9668
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009669
96706. HTTP header manipulation
9671---------------------------
9672
9673In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
9674response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
9675request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
9676which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009677against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009678
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009679If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
9680to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
9681but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
9682HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
9683stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
9684because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
9685a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
9686still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02009687
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009688This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
9689in section 4.2 :
9690
9691 - reqadd <string>
9692 - reqallow <search>
9693 - reqiallow <search>
9694 - reqdel <search>
9695 - reqidel <search>
9696 - reqdeny <search>
9697 - reqideny <search>
9698 - reqpass <search>
9699 - reqipass <search>
9700 - reqrep <search> <replace>
9701 - reqirep <search> <replace>
9702 - reqtarpit <search>
9703 - reqitarpit <search>
9704 - rspadd <string>
9705 - rspdel <search>
9706 - rspidel <search>
9707 - rspdeny <search>
9708 - rspideny <search>
9709 - rsprep <search> <replace>
9710 - rspirep <search> <replace>
9711
9712With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
9713is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
9714parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
9715prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
9716Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
9717
9718 \t for a tab
9719 \r for a carriage return (CR)
9720 \n for a new line (LF)
9721 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
9722 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
9723 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
9724 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
9725 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
9726
9727The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
9728portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
9729above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
9730regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
97319 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
9732is very common to users of the "sed" program.
9733
9734The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
9735after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
9736
9737Notes related to these keywords :
9738---------------------------------
9739 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
9740 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
9741 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
9742
9743 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
9744 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
9745 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
9746
9747 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
9748 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
9749 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
9750 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
9751 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
9752
9753 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
9754 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
9755 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
9756 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
9757 useless headers before adding new ones.
9758
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009759 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009760 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
9761
9762 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
9763 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
9764 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
9765
9766 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
9767 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009768 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009769
9770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097717. Using ACLs and fetching samples
9772----------------------------------
9773
9774Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
9775client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
9776The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
9777these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
9778but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
9779data called patterns.
9780
9781
97827.1. ACL basics
9783---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009784
9785The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
9786content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
9787from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
9788simple :
9789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009790 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009791 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009792 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
9793 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009795The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
9796adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009797
9798In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
9799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009800 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009801
9802This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
9803Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
9804and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009805an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
9806conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
9807as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
9808are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009809
9810ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
9811'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
9812which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
9813
9814There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
9815performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
9816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009817The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
9818specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
9819this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009820methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
9821ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009822
9823Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
9824 - boolean
9825 - integer (signed or unsigned)
9826 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
9827 - string
9828 - data block
9829
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009830Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
9831converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
9832would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
9833The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
9834which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
9835
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009836Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
9837keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
9838fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
9839which are summarized in the table below :
9840
9841 +---------------------+-----------------+
9842 | Sample or converter | Default |
9843 | output type | matching method |
9844 +---------------------+-----------------+
9845 | boolean | bool |
9846 +---------------------+-----------------+
9847 | integer | int |
9848 +---------------------+-----------------+
9849 | ip | ip |
9850 +---------------------+-----------------+
9851 | string | str |
9852 +---------------------+-----------------+
9853 | binary | none, use "-m" |
9854 +---------------------+-----------------+
9855
9856Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
9857matching method, see below.
9858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009859The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
9860 - boolean
9861 - integer or integer range
9862 - IP address / network
9863 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
9864 - regular expression
9865 - hex block
9866
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009867The following ACL flags are currently supported :
9868
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009869 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
9870 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009871 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009872 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009873 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009874 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009875 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
9876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009877The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
9878read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
9879if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
9880lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
9881will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
9882beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
9883a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
9884lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
9885exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
9886
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009887The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
9888parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
9889ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
9890a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
9891check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
9892
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009893The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
9894socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
9895file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
9896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009897Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
9898loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
9899
9900 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
9901
9902In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
9903the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
9904case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
9905as well.
9906
9907The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
9908sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
9909do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
9910methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
9911is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
9912obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
9913followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
9914default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
9915that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
9916string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
9917
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009918The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
9919By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
9920string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
9921resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
9922server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
9923waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
9924flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
9925function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
9926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009927There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
9928sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
9929be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009930
9931 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
9932 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009933 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
9934 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
9935 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
9936 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009937
9938 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
9939 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009940 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009941
9942 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009943 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009944
9945 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009946 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009947
9948 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
9949 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
9950
9951 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
9952 binary or string samples.
9953
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009954 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
9955 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009957 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
9958 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
9959 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009961 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
9962 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009963
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009964 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
9965 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009967 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
9968 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009969
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009970 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
9971 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009972 This may be used with binary or string samples.
9973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009974 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
9975 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
9976 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009977
9978For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
9979request, it is possible to do :
9980
9981 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
9982
9983In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
9984buffer, one would use the following acl :
9985
9986 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
9987
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009988On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
9989possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
9990
9991 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
9992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009993All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
9994criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
9995method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
9996to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
9997criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
9998the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009999
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010000If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010001the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
10002For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010004 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
10005 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
10006 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
10007 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010008
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010009
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010010The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
10011types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
10012combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
10013brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
10014default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010016 +-------------------------------------------------+
10017 | Input sample type |
10018 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010019 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010020 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
10021 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
10022 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010023 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010024 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010025 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010026 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010027 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010028 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010029 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010030 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010031 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010032 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010033 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010034 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010035 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010036 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010037 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010038 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010039 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010040 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010041 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010042 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010043 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010044 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
10045 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
10046 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010047
10048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200100497.1.1. Matching booleans
10050------------------------
10051
10052In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
10053Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
10054When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
10055that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
10056
10057Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
10058return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
10059"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
10060
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200100627.1.2. Matching integers
10063------------------------
10064
10065Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
10066enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
10067to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
10068
10069Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
10070matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
10071lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010072
10073For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
10074unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
10075representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
10076
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010077As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
10078two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
10079instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
10080ranges and operators.
10081
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010082For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010083operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
10084Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
10085of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010086
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010087Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010088
10089 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
10090 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
10091 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
10092 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
10093 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
10094
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010095For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010096
10097 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
10098
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010099This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
10100
10101 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
10102
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200101047.1.3. Matching strings
10105-----------------------
10106
10107String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
10108different forms :
10109
10110 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
10111 patterns ;
10112
10113 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
10114 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
10115
10116 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
10117 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
10118
10119 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
10120 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
10121
10122 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
10123 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
10124 matches.
10125
10126 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
10127 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
10128 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010129
10130String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
10131exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
10132characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
10133string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
10134to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010135before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010136
10137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200101387.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
10139---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010140
10141Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
10142they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
10143possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
10144passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
10145the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010146the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
10147match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010148
10149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200101507.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
10151-------------------------------------
10152
10153It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
10154not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
10155a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
10156to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
10157digits may be used upper or lower case.
10158
10159Example :
10160 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
10161 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
10162
10163
101647.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
10165---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010166
10167IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
10168netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
10169within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010170host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010171difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
10172at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
10173does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
10174parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010175
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010176IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
10177Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
10178trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
10179IPv6 patterns.
10180
10181HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
10182following situations :
10183 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
10184 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
10185 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
10186 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
10187 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
10188 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
10189 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
10190 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
10191 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
10192 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
10193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010194
101957.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
10196----------------------------------
10197
10198Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
10199combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
10200
10201 - AND (implicit)
10202 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
10203 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010205A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010207 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020010208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010209Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
10210indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020010211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010212For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
10213"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
10214requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
10215is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
10216
10217 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
10218 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
10219 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
10220 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
10221
10222To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
10223and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
10224
10225 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
10226 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
10227 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
10228 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
10229
10230 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
10231 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
10232 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
10233 use_backend www if host_www
10234
10235It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
10236expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
10237be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
10238the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
10239
10240 The following rule :
10241
10242 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
10243 block if METH_POST missing_cl
10244
10245 Can also be written that way :
10246
10247 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
10248
10249It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
10250to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
10251simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
10252sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
10253good use is the following :
10254
10255 With named ACLs :
10256
10257 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
10258 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
10259 monitor fail if site_dead
10260
10261 With anonymous ACLs :
10262
10263 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
10264
10265See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
10266
10267
102687.3. Fetching samples
10269---------------------
10270
10271Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
10272against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
10273sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
10274ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
10275of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
10276available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
10277
10278This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
10279Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
10280compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
10281deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
10282
10283The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
10284matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
10285method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
10286indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
10287
10288As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
10289when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
10290mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
10291the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
10292ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
10293
10294Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
10295multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
10296when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
10297incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
10298are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
10299is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
10300all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
10301
10302Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
10303 - name
10304 - name(arg1)
10305 - name(arg1,arg2)
10306
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010307
103087.3.1. Converters
10309-----------------
10310
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010311Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
10312of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
10313is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
10314was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
10315has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
10316unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
10317
10318These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
10319sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
10320the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
10321support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010322
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010323A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
10324support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
10325supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
10326(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
10327bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
10328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010329The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010330
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010331add(<value>)
10332 Adds <value> to the input value of type unsigned integer, and returns the
10333 result as an unsigned integer.
10334
10335and(<value>)
10336 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type unsigned
10337 integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10338
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020010339base64
10340 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
10341 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
10342 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
10343
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010344bool
10345 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is
10346 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
10347 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
10348 presence of a flag).
10349
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010010350bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
10351 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
10352 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
10353 optionnaly truncated at the given length.
10354
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010355cpl
10356 Takes the input value of type unsigned integer, applies a twos-complement
10357 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10358
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010359crc32([<avalanche>])
10360 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
10361 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10362 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10363 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10364 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10365 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
10366 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
10367 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
10368 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
10369 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
10370 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
10371
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010372div(<value>)
10373 Divides the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns the
10374 result as an unsigned integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
10375 integer is returned (typically 2^32-1).
10376
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010377djb2([<avalanche>])
10378 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
10379 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10380 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10381 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10382 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10383 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10384 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010385 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
10386 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010387
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010388even
10389 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is even
10390 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
10391
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010010392field(<index>,<delimiters>)
10393 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
10394 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
10395 list of chars.
10396
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010397hex
10398 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
10399 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
10400 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
10401 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010010402
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010403http_date([<offset>])
10404 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10405 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
10406 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
10407 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
10408 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
10409 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010410
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020010411in_table(<table>)
10412 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10413 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
10414 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
10415 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
10416 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
10417
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010418ipmask(<mask>)
10419 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
10420 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
10421 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
10422 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
10423
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020010424json([<input-code>])
10425 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
10426 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
10427 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8"" or
10428 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
10429 of errors:
10430 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
10431 bytes, ...)
10432 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
10433 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
10434
10435 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
10436 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
10437 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
10438 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
10439 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
10440 are :
10441 - "ascii" : never fails ;
10442 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
10443 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
10444 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
10445 error ;
10446 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
10447 characters corresponding to the other errors.
10448
10449 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
10450 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
10451
10452 Example:
10453 capture request header user-agent len 150
10454 capture request header Host len 15
10455 log-format {"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json]"}
10456
10457 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
10458 GET / HTTP/1.0
10459 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
10460
10461 Output log:
10462 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
10463
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010464language(<value>[,<default>])
10465 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
10466 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
10467 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
10468 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
10469 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
10470 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
10471 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
10472 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
10473 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
10474 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
10475 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
10476 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010477
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010478 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010479
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010480 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
10481 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010482
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010483 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
10484 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
10485 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
10486 use_backend spanish if es
10487 use_backend french if fr
10488 use_backend english if en
10489 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010490
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010491lower
10492 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
10493 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10494 type. The result is of type string.
10495
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020010496ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
10497 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10498 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
10499 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
10500 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
10501 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
10502 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
10503
10504 Example :
10505
10506 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
10507 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
10508 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
10509
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010510map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10511map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10512map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10513 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
10514 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
10515 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
10516 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
10517 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
10518 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
10519 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
10520 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010521
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010522 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
10523 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
10524 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010525
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010526 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
10527 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010528
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010529 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
10530 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10531 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
10532 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020010533 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
10534 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010535 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
10536 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10537 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
10538 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10539 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
10540 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10541 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
10542 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10543 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
10544 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10545 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
10546 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10547 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
10548 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010549
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010550 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
10551 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
10552 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
10553 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
10554 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010555
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010556 Example :
10557
10558 # this is a comment and is ignored
10559 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
10560 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
10561 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
10562 | | | `---------- value
10563 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
10564 | `---------------------------- key
10565 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
10566
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010567mod(<value>)
10568 Divides the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns the
10569 remainder as an unsigned integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
10570
10571mul(<value>)
10572 Multiplies the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns
10573 the product as an unsigned integer. In case of overflow, the higher bits are
10574 lost, leading to seemingly strange values.
10575
10576neg
10577 Takes the input value of type unsigned integer, computes the opposite value,
10578 and returns the remainder as an unsigned integer. 0 is identity. This
10579 operator is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input
10580 from a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
10581
10582not
10583 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type unsigned integer is
10584 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
10585 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
10586 absence of a flag).
10587
10588odd
10589 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is odd
10590 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
10591
10592or(<value>)
10593 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type unsigned
10594 integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10595
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010010596regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010010597 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
10598 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
10599 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
10600 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
10601 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
10602 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
10603 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
10604 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
10605 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
10606 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
10607 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis or comma
10608 are not possible to use in the arguments. The first use of this converter is
10609 to replace certain characters or sequence of characters with other ones.
10610
10611 Example :
10612
10613 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
10614 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
10615 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
10616 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
10617
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010618sdbm([<avalanche>])
10619 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
10620 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10621 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10622 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10623 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10624 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10625 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010626 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
10627 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010628
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010629sub(<value>)
10630 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type unsigned integer, and returns
10631 the result as an unsigned integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
10632 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
10633
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020010634table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
10635 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10636 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10637 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
10638 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
10639 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
10640 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
10641
10642
10643table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
10644 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10645 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10646 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
10647 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
10648 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
10649 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
10650
10651table_conn_cnt(<table>)
10652 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10653 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10654 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
10655 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
10656 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10657
10658table_conn_cur(<table>)
10659 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10660 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10661 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
10662 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
10663 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
10664
10665table_conn_rate(<table>)
10666 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10667 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10668 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
10669 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
10670 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
10671
10672table_gpc0(<table>)
10673 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10674 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10675 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
10676 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
10677 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
10678
10679table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
10680 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10681 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10682 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
10683 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
10684 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
10685 sample fetch keyword.
10686
10687table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
10688 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10689 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10690 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
10691 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
10692 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10693
10694table_http_err_rate(<table>)
10695 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10696 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10697 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
10698 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
10699 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
10700 keyword.
10701
10702table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
10703 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10704 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10705 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
10706 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
10707 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10708
10709table_http_req_rate(<table>)
10710 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10711 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10712 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
10713 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
10714 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
10715 keyword.
10716
10717table_kbytes_in(<table>)
10718 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10719 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10720 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
10721 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
10722 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
10723 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
10724 keyword.
10725
10726table_kbytes_out(<table>)
10727 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10728 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10729 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
10730 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
10731 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
10732 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
10733 keyword.
10734
10735table_server_id(<table>)
10736 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10737 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10738 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
10739 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
10740 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
10741 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
10742
10743table_sess_cnt(<table>)
10744 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10745 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10746 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
10747 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
10748 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
10749 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
10750 keyword.
10751
10752table_sess_rate(<table>)
10753 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10754 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10755 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
10756 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
10757 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
10758 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
10759 keyword.
10760
10761table_trackers(<table>)
10762 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10763 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10764 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
10765 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
10766 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
10767 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
10768 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
10769 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
10770 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
10771 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
10772
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010773upper
10774 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
10775 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10776 type. The result is of type string.
10777
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020010778utime(<format>[,<offset>])
10779 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10780 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
10781 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
10782 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
10783 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
10784 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
10785
10786 Example :
10787
10788 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
10789 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
10790 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
10791
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010010792word(<index>,<delimiters>)
10793 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
10794 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
10795
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010796wt6([<avalanche>])
10797 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
10798 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10799 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10800 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10801 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10802 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10803 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010804 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
10805 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010806
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010807xor(<value>)
10808 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
10809 of type unsigned integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10810
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010811
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200108127.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010813--------------------------------------------
10814
10815A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
10816not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
10817"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
10818The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
10819
10820always_false : boolean
10821 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10822 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10823
10824always_true : boolean
10825 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10826 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10827
10828avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010829 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010830 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
10831 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
10832 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
10833 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
10834 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
10835 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
10836 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
10837 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
10838 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
10839 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
10840 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
10841 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
10842 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010010843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010844be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010845 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
10846 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
10847 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
10848 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
10849 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010851be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
10852 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10853 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10854 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
10855 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
10856 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
10857 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010858
10859 Example :
10860 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
10861 backend dynamic
10862 mode http
10863 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
10864 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010866connslots([<backend>]) : integer
10867 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010868 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010869 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
10870 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050010871
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010872 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010873 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010874 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
10875
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010876 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
10877 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010878
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010879 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010880 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010881 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010882 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
10883 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010884 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010885 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010886
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010887 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
10888 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010889 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010890 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010891
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010892date([<offset>]) : integer
10893 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
10894 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
10895 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
10896 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020010897 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
10898
10899 Example :
10900
10901 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
10902 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010903
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020010904env(<name>) : string
10905 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
10906 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
10907 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
10908 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
10909 certain way.
10910
10911 Examples :
10912 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
10913 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
10914
10915 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
10916 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
10917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010918fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
10919 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010920 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
10921 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010922 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
10923 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
10924 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
10925 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
10926 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010928fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
10929 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10930 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10931 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
10932 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
10933 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
10934 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
10935 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
10936 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010937
10938 Example :
10939 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
10940 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
10941 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
10942 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
10943 frontend mail
10944 bind :25
10945 mode tcp
10946 maxconn 100
10947 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
10948 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
10949 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
10950 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010951
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010952nbproc : integer
10953 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
10954 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
10955 and debugging purposes.
10956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010957nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
10958 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
10959 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
10960 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010961 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
10962 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
10963 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010964
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010965proc : integer
10966 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
10967 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
10968 debugging purposes.
10969
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010970queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010971 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
10972 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
10973 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010974 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
10975 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
10976 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
10977 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
10978 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
10979
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010010980rand([<range>]) : integer
10981 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
10982 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
10983 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
10984 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
10985 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
10986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010987srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10988 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10989 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
10990 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
10991 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
10992 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
10993 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
10994 methods.
10995
10996srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
10997 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
10998 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
10999 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
11000 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
11001 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
11002 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
11003 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
11004
11005srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
11006 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11007 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011008 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011009 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
11010 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
11011 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
11012 overloading servers).
11013
11014 Example :
11015 # Redirect to a separate back
11016 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
11017 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
11018 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
11019
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011020stopping : boolean
11021 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
11022 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
11023 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
11024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011025table_avl([<table>]) : integer
11026 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
11027 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
11028
11029table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11030 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
11031 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
11032 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
11033
11034
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200110357.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011036----------------------------------
11037
11038The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
11039closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
11040methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
11041sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
11042TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011043the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
11044counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
11045"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011046argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
11047the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
11048this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011049
11050be_id : integer
11051 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
11052 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
11053
11054dst : ip
11055 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
11056 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
11057 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
11058 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
11059 RFC 4291.
11060
11061dst_conn : integer
11062 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
11063 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
11064 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
11065 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
11066 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
11067 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
11068 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
11069 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011071dst_port : integer
11072 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
11073 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
11074 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
11075 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
11076 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
11077 an HTTP header.
11078
11079fe_id : integer
11080 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
11081 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
11082 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
11083
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011084sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011085sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11086sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11087sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011088 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
11089 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
11090 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
11091
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011092sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011093sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11094sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11095sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011096 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
11097 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
11098 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
11099
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011100sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011101sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11102sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11103sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011104 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
11105 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011106 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
11107 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
11108 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011109
11110 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
11111 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011112 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
11113 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
11114 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011115 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
11116 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11117
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011118sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011119sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11120sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11121sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011122 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
11123 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
11124
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011125sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011126sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
11127sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
11128sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011129 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
11130 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
11131 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
11132
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011133sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011134sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11135sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11136sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011137 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
11138 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
11139 See also src_conn_rate.
11140
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011141sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011142sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11143sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11144sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011145 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011146 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011147
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011148sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011149sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
11150sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
11151sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011152 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11153 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
11154 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011155 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
11156 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
11157 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011158
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011159sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011160sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11161sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11162sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011163 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
11164 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
11165 See also src_http_err_cnt.
11166
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011167sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011168sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11169sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11170sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011171 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
11172 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
11173 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
11174 src_http_err_rate.
11175
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011176sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011177sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11178sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11179sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011180 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
11181 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
11182 src_http_req_cnt.
11183
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011184sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011185sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11186sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11187sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011188 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
11189 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
11190 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
11191 src_http_req_rate.
11192
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011193sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011194sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11195sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11196sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011197 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011198 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
11199 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
11200 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
11201 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011202
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011203 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
11204 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011205 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11206
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011207sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011208sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
11209sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
11210sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011211 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
11212 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
11213 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011214
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011215sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011216sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
11217sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
11218sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011219 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
11220 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
11221 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011222
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011223sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011224sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11225sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11226sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011227 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
11228 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
11229 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
11230 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011231 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011232 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
11233
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011234sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011235sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11236sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11237sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011238 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
11239 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
11240 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
11241 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
11242 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011243 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011244
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011245sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011246sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
11247sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
11248sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020011249 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
11250 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
11251 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
11252
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011253sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011254sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
11255sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
11256sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010011257 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
11258 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011259 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010011260 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
11261 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011262 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
11263 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
11264 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010011265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011266so_id : integer
11267 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
11268 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
11269 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011270
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011271src : ip
11272 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
11273 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
11274 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
11275 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
11276 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
11277 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
11278 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011279
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011280 Example:
11281 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
11282 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
11283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011284src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11285 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
11286 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
11287 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011288 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011290src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11291 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
11292 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011293 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011294 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011296src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11297 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
11298 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11299 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
11300 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
11301 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
11302 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011303
11304 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
11305 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
11306 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
11307 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011308 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011309 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
11310 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11311
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011312src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011313 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011314 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011315 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011316 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011317
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011318src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011319 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011320 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
11321 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011322 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011323
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011324src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11325 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
11326 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11327 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011328 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011330src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011331 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011332 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011333 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011334 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011336src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011337 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011338 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011339 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
11340 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011341 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
11342 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
11343 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011345src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11346 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
11347 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011348 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011349 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011350 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011352src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11353 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
11354 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11355 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
11356 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011357 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011359src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11360 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
11361 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
11362 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011363 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011365src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11366 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
11367 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
11368 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011369 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011370 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011372src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11373 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
11374 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11375 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011376 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011377 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
11378 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011379
11380 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011381 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011382 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011384src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011385 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
11386 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
11387 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
11388 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
11389 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011390
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011391src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011392 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
11393 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11394 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
11395 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
11396 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011398src_port : integer
11399 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
11400 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
11401 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
11402 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011404src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11405 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011406 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11407 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
11408 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011409 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011410
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011411src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11412 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
11413 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11414 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
11415 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011416 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011418src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11419 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
11420 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
11421 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
11422 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
11423 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
11424 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
11425 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
11426 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011427
11428 Example :
11429 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
11430 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
11431 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
11432 listen ssh
11433 bind :22
11434 mode tcp
11435 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011436 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011437 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011438 server local 127.0.0.1:22
11439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011440srv_id : integer
11441 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
11442 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
11443 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020011444
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010011445
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200114467.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011447----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020011448
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011449The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
11450closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
11451when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
11452usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011453future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020011454
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011455ssl_bc : boolean
11456 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
11457 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
11458 other a server with the "ssl" option.
11459
11460ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
11461 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
11462 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11463
11464ssl_bc_cipher : string
11465 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
11466 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11467
11468ssl_bc_protocol : string
11469 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
11470 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11471
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011472ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011473 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011474 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
11475 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011476
11477ssl_bc_session_id : binary
11478 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
11479 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
11480 if session was reused or not.
11481
11482ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
11483 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
11484 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011486ssl_c_ca_err : integer
11487 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11488 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
11489 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
11490 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
11491 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020011492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011493ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
11494 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11495 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
11496 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
11497 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011498
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010011499ssl_c_der : binary
11500 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
11501 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11502 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
11503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011504ssl_c_err : integer
11505 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11506 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
11507 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
11508 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
11509 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011511ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11512 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11513 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
11514 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11515 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11516 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11517 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11518 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11519 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011521ssl_c_key_alg : string
11522 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
11523 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11524 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011526ssl_c_notafter : string
11527 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
11528 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11529 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011531ssl_c_notbefore : string
11532 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
11533 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11534 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010011535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011536ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11537 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11538 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
11539 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11540 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11541 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11542 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11543 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11544 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010011545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011546ssl_c_serial : binary
11547 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
11548 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11549 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011551ssl_c_sha1 : binary
11552 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
11553 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
11554 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020011555 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
11556 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
11557
11558 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011560ssl_c_sig_alg : string
11561 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
11562 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
11563 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011565ssl_c_used : boolean
11566 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
11567 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011569ssl_c_verify : integer
11570 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
11571 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
11572 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
11573 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011575ssl_c_version : integer
11576 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
11577 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011578
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010011579ssl_f_der : binary
11580 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
11581 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11582 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
11583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011584ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11585 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11586 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
11587 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11588 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011589 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011590 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11591 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11592 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011594ssl_f_key_alg : string
11595 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
11596 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
11597 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011599ssl_f_notafter : string
11600 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
11601 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11602 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011604ssl_f_notbefore : string
11605 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
11606 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11607 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011609ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11610 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11611 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
11612 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11613 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11614 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11615 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11616 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11617 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011619ssl_f_serial : binary
11620 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
11621 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11622 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011623
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020011624ssl_f_sha1 : binary
11625 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
11626 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
11627 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
11628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011629ssl_f_sig_alg : string
11630 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
11631 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
11632 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011634ssl_f_version : integer
11635 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
11636 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11637
11638ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011639 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
11640 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
11641 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
11642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011643 Example :
11644 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
11645 listen http-https
11646 bind :80
11647 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
11648 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
11649
11650ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
11651 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
11652 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11653
11654ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011655 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011656 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
11657 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
11658 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
11659 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
11660 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
11661 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
11662 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
11663 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
11664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011665ssl_fc_cipher : string
11666 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
11667 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011669ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011670 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
11671 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010011672 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
11673 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
11674 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
11675 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011677ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
11678 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020011679 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
11680 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
11681 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
11682 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011684ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011685 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011686 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
11687 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
11688 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
11689 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
11690 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
11691 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
11692 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020011693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011694ssl_fc_protocol : string
11695 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
11696 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011697
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011698ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040011699 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011700 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
11701 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040011702
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011703ssl_fc_session_id : binary
11704 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
11705 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
11706 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
11707 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011709ssl_fc_sni : string
11710 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
11711 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
11712 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
11713 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
11714 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
11715
11716 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
11717 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
11718 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020011719 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
11720 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011722 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011723 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
11724 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020011725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011726ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
11727 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
11728 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011729
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011730
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200117317.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011732------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011734Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
11735sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
11736only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
11737For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
11738be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
11739can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
11740sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
11741for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
11742content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011744payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
11745 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
11746 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
11747 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011748
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011749payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
11750 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
11751 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
11752 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011754req.len : integer
11755req_len : integer (deprecated)
11756 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11757 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11758 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11759 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11760 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11761 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11762 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
11763 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011765req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11766 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011767 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11768 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11769 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11770 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011772 ACL alternatives :
11773 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011775req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11776 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11777 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11778 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
11779 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011781 ACL alternatives :
11782 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011784 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011786req.proto_http : boolean
11787req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
11788 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
11789 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
11790 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
11791 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
11792 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
11793 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
11794 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011796 Example:
11797 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11798 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11799 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011800 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011802req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
11803rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11804 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
11805 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
11806 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
11807 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
11808 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
11809 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
11810 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011812 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
11813 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
11814 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
11815 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
11816 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
11817 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011819 ACL derivatives :
11820 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011822 Example :
11823 listen tse-farm
11824 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
11825 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
11826 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11827 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
11828 # apply RDP cookie persistence
11829 persist rdp-cookie
11830 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
11831 # This is only useful makes sense if
11832 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
11833 stick-table type string size 204800
11834 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
11835 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
11836 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011838 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
11839 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011841req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
11842rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
11843 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
11844 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
11845 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
11846 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011848 ACL derivatives :
11849 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011851req.ssl_hello_type : integer
11852req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11853 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11854 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
11855 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11856 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11857 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
11858 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11859 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011861req.ssl_sni : string
11862req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
11863 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
11864 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
11865 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
11866 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11867 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11868 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
11869 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
11870 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
11871 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
11872 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
11873 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
11874 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011876 ACL derivatives :
11877 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011879 Examples :
11880 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
11881 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11882 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
11883 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
11884 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011886res.ssl_hello_type : integer
11887rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11888 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11889 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
11890 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11891 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11892 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
11893 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11894 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020011895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011896req.ssl_ver : integer
11897req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
11898 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
11899 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
11900 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
11901 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
11902 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11903 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11904 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
11905 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
11906 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011908 ACL derivatives :
11909 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011910
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020011911res.len : integer
11912 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11913 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11914 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11915 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11916 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11917 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11918 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
11919 content inspection.
11920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011921res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11922 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011923 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11924 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11925 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11926 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011928res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11929 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11930 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11931 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
11932 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011934 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011936wait_end : boolean
11937 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
11938 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
11939 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
11940 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
11941 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
11942 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
11943 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
11944 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011946 Examples :
11947 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
11948 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
11949 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011951 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
11952 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11953 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
11954 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
11955 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
11956 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
11957 tcp-request content reject
11958
11959
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200119607.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011961--------------------------------------
11962
11963It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
11964This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
11965data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
11966its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
11967HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
11968content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
11969to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
11970more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
11971response are indexed.
11972
11973base : string
11974 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
11975 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
11976 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
11977 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
11978 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
11979 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
11980 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
11981 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
11982
11983 ACL derivatives :
11984 base : exact string match
11985 base_beg : prefix match
11986 base_dir : subdir match
11987 base_dom : domain match
11988 base_end : suffix match
11989 base_len : length match
11990 base_reg : regex match
11991 base_sub : substring match
11992
11993base32 : integer
11994 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
11995 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
11996 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011997 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
11998 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
11999 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012000
12001base32+src : binary
12002 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
12003 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
12004 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
12005 per-URL counters.
12006
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010012007capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
12008 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
12009 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
12010 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
12011
12012capture.req.method : string
12013 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
12014 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
12015 because it's allocated.
12016
12017capture.req.uri : string
12018 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
12019 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
12020 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
12021 allocated.
12022
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020012023capture.req.ver : string
12024 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
12025 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
12026 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
12027
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010012028capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
12029 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
12030 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
12031 The first entry is an index of 0.
12032 See also: "capture response header"
12033
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020012034capture.res.ver : string
12035 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
12036 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
12037 persistent flag.
12038
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012039req.cook([<name>]) : string
12040cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12041 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12042 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
12043 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
12044 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
12045 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
12046 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
12047 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
12048 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
12049
12050 ACL derivatives :
12051 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
12052 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
12053 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
12054 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
12055 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
12056 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
12057 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
12058 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012060req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12061cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12062 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
12063 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012065req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
12066cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12067 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12068 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
12069 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
12070 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012072cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12073 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12074 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
12075 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
12076 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
12077 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
12078 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
12079 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
12080 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
12081 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
12082 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012084hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12085 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
12086 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
12087 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
12088 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012089 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012091req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
12092 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
12093 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
12094 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12095 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12096 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12097 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
12098 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
12099 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012101req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12102 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
12103 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12104 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
12105 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012107req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12108 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
12109 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
12110 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12111 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12112 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12113 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
12114 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
12115 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
12116 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
12117 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
12118 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012119
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012120 ACL derivatives :
12121 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
12122 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
12123 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
12124 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
12125 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
12126 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
12127 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
12128 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
12129
12130req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12131hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
12132 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
12133 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
12134 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
12135 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
12136 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
12137 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
12138 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
12139 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
12140 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
12141
12142req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
12143hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
12144 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
12145 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
12146 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
12147 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
12148 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
12149 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
12150 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
12151 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
12152
12153req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
12154hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
12155 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
12156 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
12157 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
12158 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12159 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12160 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12161 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
12162
12163http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
12164 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
12165 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
12166 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
12167 basic auth is supported.
12168
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010012169http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
12170 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
12171 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
12172 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
12173 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012174 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
12175 basic auth is supported.
12176
12177 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010012178 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
12179 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
12180 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
12181 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012182
12183http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020012184 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
12185 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012186 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
12187 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020012188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012189method : integer + string
12190 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
12191 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
12192 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
12193 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
12194 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
12195 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
12196 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012198 ACL derivatives :
12199 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012201 Example :
12202 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
12203 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
12204 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012206path : string
12207 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
12208 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
12209 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
12210 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
12211 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
12212 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
12213 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012215 ACL derivatives :
12216 path : exact string match
12217 path_beg : prefix match
12218 path_dir : subdir match
12219 path_dom : domain match
12220 path_end : suffix match
12221 path_len : length match
12222 path_reg : regex match
12223 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012224
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010012225query : string
12226 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
12227 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
12228 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
12229 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
12230 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the completemnt of "path"
12231 which stops before the question mark.
12232
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010012233req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
12234 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
12235 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
12236 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
12237 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
12238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012239req.ver : string
12240req_ver : string (deprecated)
12241 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
12242 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
12243 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012245 ACL derivatives :
12246 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012248res.comp : boolean
12249 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
12250 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
12251 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012253res.comp_algo : string
12254 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
12255 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
12256 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012258res.cook([<name>]) : string
12259scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12260 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
12261 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
12262 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020012263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012264 ACL derivatives :
12265 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020012266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012267res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12268scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12269 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
12270 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
12271 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012273res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
12274scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12275 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
12276 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
12277 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012279res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12280 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
12281 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
12282 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
12283 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
12284 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
12285 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
12286 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
12287 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
12288 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012290res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12291 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
12292 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12293 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
12294 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
12295 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012297res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12298shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
12299 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
12300 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
12301 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
12302 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
12303 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
12304 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
12305 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
12306 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012307
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012308 ACL derivatives :
12309 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
12310 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
12311 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
12312 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
12313 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
12314 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
12315 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
12316 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
12317
12318res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12319shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12320 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
12321 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12322 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
12323 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
12324 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012325
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012326res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
12327shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
12328 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
12329 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
12330 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
12331 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
12332 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
12333 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012334
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010012335res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
12336 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
12337 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
12338 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
12339 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
12340
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012341res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
12342shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
12343 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
12344 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
12345 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
12346 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
12347 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
12348 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010012349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012350res.ver : string
12351resp_ver : string (deprecated)
12352 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
12353 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012355 ACL derivatives :
12356 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010012357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012358set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12359 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
12360 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
12361 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
12362 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010012363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012364 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
12365 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010012366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012367 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012368
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012369status : integer
12370 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
12371 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
12372 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012374url : string
12375 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
12376 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
12377 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
12378 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
12379 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
12380 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
12381 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012383 ACL derivatives :
12384 url : exact string match
12385 url_beg : prefix match
12386 url_dir : subdir match
12387 url_dom : domain match
12388 url_end : suffix match
12389 url_len : length match
12390 url_reg : regex match
12391 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012393url_ip : ip
12394 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
12395 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
12396 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
12397 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
12398 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
12399 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
12400 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012402url_port : integer
12403 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
12404 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
12405 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
12406 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012407
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012408urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
12409url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
12410 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
12411 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
12412 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
12413 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
12414 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
12415 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
12416 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
12417 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
12418 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012420 ACL derivatives :
12421 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
12422 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
12423 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
12424 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
12425 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
12426 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
12427 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
12428 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012429
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012431 Example :
12432 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
12433 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
12434 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
12435 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012437urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
12438 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
12439 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
12440 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020012441
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010012442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200124437.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012444---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012445
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012446Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
12447every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012448order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012449
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012450ACL name Equivalent to Usage
12451---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012452FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020012453HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012454HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
12455HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012456HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
12457HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
12458HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
12459HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
12460LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012461METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
12462METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
12463METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
12464METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
12465METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
12466METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020012467RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012468REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012469TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012470WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
12471---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012472
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012473
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124748. Logging
12475----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012476
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012477One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
12478provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
12479very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
12480provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
12481state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012482to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012483headers.
12484
12485In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
12486about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
12487send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
12488
12489 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
12490 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
12491 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
12492 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
12493 at the termination.
12494
12495The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
12496allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
12497as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
12498while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
12499real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
12500delay.
12501
12502
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125038.1. Log levels
12504---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012505
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012506TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012507source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012508HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
12509in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
12510track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
12511syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
12512about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012513
12514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125158.2. Log formats
12516----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012517
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012518HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012519and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
12520slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
12521options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012522
12523 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
12524 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
12525 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
12526 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
12527 extents.
12528
12529 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
12530 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
12531 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
12532 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
12533 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
12534
12535 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
12536 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
12537 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
12538 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
12539 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
12540
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020012541 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
12542 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
12543 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
12544 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
12545
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012546 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
12547
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012548Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
12549specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
12550field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
12551servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
12552always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
12553identifier.
12554
12555Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
12556 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
12557 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
12558 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
12559 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
12560
12561
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125628.2.1. Default log format
12563-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012564
12565This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
12566as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
12567format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
12568
12569 Example :
12570 listen www
12571 mode http
12572 log global
12573 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12574
12575 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
12576 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
12577 (www/HTTP)
12578
12579 Field Format Extract from the example above
12580 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
12581 2 'Connect from' Connect from
12582 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
12583 4 'to' to
12584 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
12585 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
12586
12587Detailed fields description :
12588 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
12589 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
12590 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
12591 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
12592 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12593 and processed the connection.
12594 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
12595
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012596In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
12597"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
12598connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
12599
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012600It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
12601will eventually disappear.
12602
12603
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126048.2.2. TCP log format
12605---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012606
12607The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
12608is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
12609information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
12610counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
12611emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
12612environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
12613the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
12614sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012615specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
12616not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
12617fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
12618marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012619
12620 Example :
12621 frontend fnt
12622 mode tcp
12623 option tcplog
12624 log global
12625 default_backend bck
12626
12627 backend bck
12628 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12629
12630 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
12631 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
12632 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
12633
12634 Field Format Extract from the example above
12635 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
12636 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
12637 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
12638 4 frontend_name fnt
12639 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
12640 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
12641 7 bytes_read* 212
12642 8 termination_state --
12643 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
12644 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12645
12646Detailed fields description :
12647 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012648 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12649 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12650 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12651 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12652 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012653
12654 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012655 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12656 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12657 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012658
12659 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
12660 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
12661 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
12662 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
12663
12664 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12665 and processed the connection.
12666
12667 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
12668 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
12669 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
12670 applications.
12671
12672 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
12673 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
12674 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
12675 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
12676 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
12677
12678 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12679 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12680 See "Timers" below for more details.
12681
12682 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12683 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12684 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
12685 "Timers" below for more details.
12686
12687 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012688 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012689 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12690 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12691 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12692 details.
12693
12694 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
12695 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
12696 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
12697 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
12698 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
12699
12700 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
12701 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
12702 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
12703 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
12704 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
12705 for more details.
12706
12707 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012708 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012709 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
12710 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
12711 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012712 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012713
12714 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
12715 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
12716 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
12717 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
12718 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
12719 caused by a denial of service attack.
12720
12721 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
12722 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
12723 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
12724 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
12725 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
12726 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
12727 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12728 denial of service attack.
12729
12730 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12731 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12732 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12733 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12734 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12735 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12736 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12737 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
12738 be processed than on other servers.
12739
12740 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12741 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12742 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12743 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12744 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12745 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12746 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12747 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12748 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12749 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12750 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12751 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12752 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12753
12754 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12755 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12756 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12757 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12758 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12759 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12760 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12761 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12762
12763 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12764 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12765 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12766 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12767 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12768 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12769 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12770 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12771 occurs.
12772
12773
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127748.2.3. HTTP log format
12775----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012776
12777The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
12778is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
12779the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
12780are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
12781emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
12782generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
12783"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
12784which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012785frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
12786is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012787
12788Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
12789slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
12790with a star ('*') after the field name below.
12791
12792 Example :
12793 frontend http-in
12794 mode http
12795 option httplog
12796 log global
12797 default_backend bck
12798
12799 backend static
12800 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12801
12802 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
12803 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
12804 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012805 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012806
12807 Field Format Extract from the example above
12808 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
12809 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
12810 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
12811 4 frontend_name http-in
12812 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
12813 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
12814 7 status_code 200
12815 8 bytes_read* 2750
12816 9 captured_request_cookie -
12817 10 captured_response_cookie -
12818 11 termination_state ----
12819 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
12820 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12821 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
12822 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
12823 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012824
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012825
12826Detailed fields description :
12827 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012828 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12829 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12830 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12831 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12832 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012833
12834 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012835 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12836 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12837 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012838
12839 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
12840 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
12841 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
12842 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
12843 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
12844
12845 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12846 and processed the connection.
12847
12848 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
12849 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
12850 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
12851
12852 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
12853 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
12854 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
12855 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
12856 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
12857 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
12858
12859 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
12860 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
12861 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
12862 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
12863 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
12864 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
12865
12866 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12867 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12868 See "Timers" below for more details.
12869
12870 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12871 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12872 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
12873 below for more details.
12874
12875 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
12876 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
12877 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
12878 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
12879 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
12880 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
12881 for more details.
12882
12883 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012884 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012885 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12886 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12887 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12888 details.
12889
12890 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
12891 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
12892 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
12893
12894 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
12895 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
12896 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
12897 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
12898 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
12899 overflowing.
12900
12901 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
12902 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
12903 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
12904 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
12905 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
12906 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
12907 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
12908 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12909
12910 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
12911 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
12912 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
12913 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
12914 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
12915 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
12916 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
12917 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12918
12919 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
12920 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
12921 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
12922 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
12923 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
12924 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
12925 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
12926
12927 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012928 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012929 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
12930 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
12931 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012932 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012933 system.
12934
12935 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
12936 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
12937 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
12938 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
12939 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
12940 caused by a denial of service attack.
12941
12942 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
12943 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
12944 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
12945 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
12946 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
12947 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
12948 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12949 denial of service attack.
12950
12951 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12952 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12953 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12954 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12955 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12956 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12957 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12958 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
12959 processed than on other servers.
12960
12961 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12962 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12963 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12964 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12965 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12966 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12967 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12968 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12969 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12970 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12971 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12972 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12973 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12974
12975 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12976 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12977 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12978 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12979 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12980 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12981 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12982 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12983
12984 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12985 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12986 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12987 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12988 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12989 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12990 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12991 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12992 occurs.
12993
12994 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
12995 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
12996 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
12997 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
12998 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
12999 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
13000 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
13001 cookies" below for more details.
13002
13003 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
13004 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
13005 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
13006 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
13007 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
13008 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
13009 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
13010 and cookies" below for more details.
13011
13012 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
13013 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
13014 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
13015 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
13016 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
13017 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
13018 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
13019 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
13020
13021
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200130228.2.4. Custom log format
13023------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013024
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013025The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013026mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013027
13028HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
13029Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
13030separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
13031prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
13032
13033Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
13034variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
13035string formats ("Q").
13036
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010013037If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020013038as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010013039less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
13040the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
13041
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013042Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013043In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010013044in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013045
13046Flags are :
13047 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013048 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013049
13050 Example:
13051
13052 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
13053 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
13054
13055At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
13056
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013057 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
13058 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013059
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013060the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013061
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013062 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020013063 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013064 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013065
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013066and the default TCP format is defined this way :
13067
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013068 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013069 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
13070
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013071Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
13072
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013073 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013074 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013075 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
13076 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
13077 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013078 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
13079 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
13080 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013081 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013082 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020013083 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013084 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013085 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080013086 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013087 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
13088 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013089 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013090 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
13091 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013092 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013093 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
13094 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013095 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
13096 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
13097 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013098 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013099 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
13100 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013101 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013102 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
13103 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
13104 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020013105 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020013106 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020013107 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
13108 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
13109 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
13110 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013111 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013112 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013113 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013114 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010013115 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013116 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013117 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
13118 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
13119 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013120 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013121 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
13122 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013123 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013124 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013125 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013126 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013127
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013128 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013129
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010013130
131318.2.5. Error log format
13132-----------------------
13133
13134When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
13135protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
13136By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
13137"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
13138will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
13139logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
13140
13141The format looks like this :
13142
13143 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
13144 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
13145 Connection error during SSL handshake
13146
13147 Field Format Extract from the example above
13148 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
13149 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
13150 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
13151 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
13152 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
13153
13154These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
13155failures.
13156
13157
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131588.3. Advanced logging options
13159-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013160
13161Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
13162just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
13163options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
13164for more information about their usage.
13165
13166
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131678.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
13168------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013169
13170It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
13171haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
13172commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
13173monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
13174ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
13175
13176 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
13177 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
13178 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
13179 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
13180
13181 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
13182 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
13183 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013184 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013185 such as other load-balancers.
13186
13187 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
13188 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
13189 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
13190
13191
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131928.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
13193----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013194
13195The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
13196what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
13197or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
13198"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
13199just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
13200log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
13201after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
13202is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
13203with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
13204with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
13205
13206
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
13208------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013209
13210Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
13211for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
13212"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
13213retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
13214raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
13215a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
13216file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
13217you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
13218"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
13219
13220
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132218.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
13222--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013223
13224Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
13225multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
13226them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
13227"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
13228logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
13229error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
13230and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
13231too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
13232useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
13233alternative.
13234
13235
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132368.4. Timing events
13237------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013238
13239Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
13240reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
13241the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
13242frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
13243mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
13244
13245 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
13246 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
13247 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
13248 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
13249 the client closes prematurely or times out.
13250
13251 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
13252 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
13253 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
13254 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
13255 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
13256
13257 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
13258 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
13259 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
13260 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
13261 connection never established.
13262
13263 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
13264 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
13265 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
13266 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
13267 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
13268 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
13269 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
13270 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
13271 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
13272 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
13273 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
13274
13275 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
13276 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
13277 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
13278 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013279 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013280
13281 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
13282
13283 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
13284 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
13285 negative.
13286
13287These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
13288protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
13289that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013290due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013291close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
13292session has been aborted on timeout.
13293
13294Most common cases :
13295
13296 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
13297 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
13298 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
13299 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
13300 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
13301 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
13302 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
13303 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
13304 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020013305 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
13306 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
13307 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013308
13309 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
13310 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
13311 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
13312 of ms on remote networks.
13313
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013314 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
13315 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
13316 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013317
13318 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
13319 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
13320 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
13321 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
13322 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
13323 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
13324 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
13325 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
13326 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
13327 to the server until another one is released.
13328
13329Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
13330
13331 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
13332 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
13333 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
13334
13335 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
13336 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
13337 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
13338
13339 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
13340 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
13341 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
13342 flags.
13343
13344 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
13345 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
13346 Check the session termination flags, then check the
13347 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
13348 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
13349 the client connection was maintained open.
13350
13351 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013352 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013353 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
13354 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
13355
13356
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133578.5. Session state at disconnection
13358-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013359
13360TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
13361"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
133622-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
13363each of which has a special meaning :
13364
13365 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
13366 session to terminate :
13367
13368 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
13369
13370 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
13371 server explicitly refused it.
13372
13373 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
13374 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
13375 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
13376 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020013377 (eg: cacheable cookie).
13378
13379 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
13380 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013381
13382 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
13383 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
13384 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
13385 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
13386 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
13387
13388 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
13389 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
13390 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
13391 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
13392 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
13393
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090013394 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
13395 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
13396
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013397 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
13398 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
13399 backup connections when going up.
13400
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020013401 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
13402
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013403 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
13404 send or receive data.
13405
13406 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
13407 send or receive data.
13408
13409 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
13410 with nothing left in the buffers.
13411
13412 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
13413
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010013414 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013415 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
13416
13417 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
13418 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
13419 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
13420 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
13421 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
13422
13423 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
13424 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
13425
13426 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
13427 server (HTTP only).
13428
13429 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
13430
13431 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
13432 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
13433 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
13434
13435 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
13436 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
13437 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
13438
13439 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
13440
13441 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
13442 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
13443
13444 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
13445 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
13446 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
13447
13448 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
13449 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020013450 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
13451 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013452
13453 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
13454 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
13455 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
13456 another server.
13457
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013458 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013459 server.
13460
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013461 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
13462 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
13463 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
13464 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
13465
13466 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
13467 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
13468 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
13469 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
13470
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020013471 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
13472 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
13473 "use-server" rule).
13474
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013475 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
13476
13477 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
13478 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
13479
13480 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
13481
13482 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
13483 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
13484 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
13485
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013486 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
13487 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013488 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013489 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
13490 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
13491
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013492 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
13493
13494 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
13495 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
13496
13497 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
13498
13499 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
13500
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013501The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
13502was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013503helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
13504starvation, attacks, etc...
13505
13506The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
13507alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
13508easier finding and understanding.
13509
13510 Flags Reason
13511
13512 -- Normal termination.
13513
13514 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
13515 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
13516 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
13517 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
13518
13519 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
13520 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
13521 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
13522 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
13523 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
13524 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013525
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013526 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
13527 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020013528 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013529
13530 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
13531 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
13532 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
13533
13534 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
13535 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
13536 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
13537 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
13538 the server takes too long to respond.
13539
13540 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
13541 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
13542 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
13543 long a time to respond.
13544
13545 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
13546 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
13547 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
13548 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
13549 and the client.
13550
13551 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
13552 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
13553 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
13554 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
13555 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020013556 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
13557 some browsers such as Google Chrome started to break the deployed Web
13558 infrastructure by aggressively implementing a new "pre-connect"
13559 feature, consisting in sending connections to sites recently visited
13560 without sending any request on them until the user starts to browse
13561 the site. This mechanism causes massive disruption among resource-
13562 limited servers, and causes a lot of 408 errors in HAProxy logs.
13563 Worse, some people report that sometimes the browser displays the 408
13564 error when the user expects to see the actual content (Mozilla fixed
13565 this bug in 2004, while Chrome users continue to report it in 2014),
13566 so in this case, using "errorfile 408 /dev/null" can be used as a
13567 workaround. More information on the subject is available here :
13568 https://bugzilla.mozilla.org/show_bug.cgi?id=248827
13569 https://code.google.com/p/chromium/issues/detail?id=85229
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013570
13571 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
13572 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013573 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
13574 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
13575 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
13576 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013577
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020013578 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
13579 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
13580
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013581 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013582 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
13583 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
13584 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
13585 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
13586 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
13587
13588 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
13589 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
13590 503 or 504 here.
13591
13592 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
13593 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
13594 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
13595 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
13596 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
13597
13598 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
13599 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013600 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013601 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
13602 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
13603
13604 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
13605 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
13606 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
13607 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
13608 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
13609 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
13610 between haproxy and the server.
13611
13612 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
13613 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
13614 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
13615 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
13616 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
13617 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
13618 solution is to fix the application.
13619
13620 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
13621 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
13622 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
13623 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
13624 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
13625 external attacks.
13626
13627 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
13628 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020013629 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013630 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
13631 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
13632
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013633 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
13634 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
13635 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020013636 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
13637 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013638
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013639 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
13640 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
13641 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
13642 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013643 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
13644 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
13645 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
13646 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
13647 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013648
13649 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
13650 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
13651 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
13652 returned an HTTP 403 error.
13653
13654 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
13655 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
13656 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
13657 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
13658
13659 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
13660 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
13661 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
13662 only be solved by proper system tuning.
13663
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013664The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
13665persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
13666important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
13667re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
13668
13669 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
13670
13671 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
13672 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
13673 set on a GET request.
13674
13675 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
13676 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013677 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013678 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
13679
13680 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
13681 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
13682 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
13683
13684 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
13685 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
13686 already got a cookie.
13687
13688 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
13689 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
13690 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
13691 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
13692 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
13693
13694 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
13695 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
13696 new cookie was inserted in the response.
13697
13698 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
13699 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
13700 new cookie was inserted in the response.
13701
13702 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
13703 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
13704
13705 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
13706 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
13707 then advertised in the response.
13708
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013709
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137108.6. Non-printable characters
13711-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013712
13713In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
13714consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
13715converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
13716prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
13717being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
13718escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
13719is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
13720'}' when logging headers.
13721
13722Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
13723issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
13724containing spaces is "User-Agent".
13725
13726Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
13727the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
13728performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
13729
13730
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137318.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
13732---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013733
13734Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
13735achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013736section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013737cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
13738the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
13739the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013740locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013741not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
13742user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
13743a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
13744wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
13745
13746 Examples :
13747 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
13748 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
13749
13750 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
13751 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
13752
13753
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137548.8. Capturing HTTP headers
13755---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013756
13757Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
13758proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
13759the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
13760server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
13761
13762Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
13763response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013764section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013765
13766It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013767time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
13768appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013769are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
13770and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
13771follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
13772request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
13773in the logs.
13774
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020013775As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
13776frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
13777an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
13778
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013779 Example :
13780 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
13781 listen proxy-out
13782 mode http
13783 option httplog
13784 option logasap
13785 log global
13786 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
13787
13788 # log the name of the virtual server
13789 capture request header Host len 20
13790
13791 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
13792 capture request header Content-Length len 10
13793
13794 # log the beginning of the referrer
13795 capture request header Referer len 20
13796
13797 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
13798 capture response header Server len 20
13799
13800 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
13801 capture response header Content-Length len 10
13802
13803 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
13804 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
13805
13806 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
13807 capture response header Via len 20
13808
13809 # log the URL location during a redirection
13810 capture response header Location len 20
13811
13812 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
13813 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
13814 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13815 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
13816 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
13817
13818 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13819 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13820 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13821 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013822 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013823
13824 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13825 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13826 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13827 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
13828 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013829 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013830
13831
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138328.9. Examples of logs
13833---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013834
13835These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
13836them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
13837reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
13838
13839 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
13840 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13841 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13842
13843 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
13844 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
13845
13846 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
13847 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
13848 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13849
13850 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
13851 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
13852
13853 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
13854 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13855 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
13856
13857 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013858 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013859 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
13860 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
13861
13862 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
13863 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
13864 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
13865
13866 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
13867 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020013868 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013869 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
13870 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
13871 to return the 502 and not the server.
13872
13873 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013874 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013875
13876 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
13877 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
13878 Nothing was sent to any server.
13879
13880 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
13881 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
13882
13883 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
13884 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
13885 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
13886 send a 408 return code to the client.
13887
13888 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
13889 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
13890
13891 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
13892 5 seconds ("c----").
13893
13894 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
13895 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013896 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013897
13898 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013899 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013900 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
13901 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
13902 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
13903 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
13904 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013905
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013906
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139079. Statistics and monitoring
13908----------------------------
13909
13910It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
13911mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
13912CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
13913Unix socket.
13914
13915
139169.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013917---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013918
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013919The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020013920page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
13921begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
13922represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
13923use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
13924('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
13925(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
13926text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
13927do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
13928use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013929
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040013930In brackets after each field name are the types which may have a value for
13931that field. The types are L (Listeners), F (Frontends), B (Backends), and
13932S (Servers).
13933
13934 0. pxname [LFBS]: proxy name
13935 1. svname [LFBS]: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend,
13936 any name for server/listener)
13937 2. qcur [..BS]: current queued requests. For the backend this reports the
13938 number queued without a server assigned.
13939 3. qmax [..BS]: max value of qcur
13940 4. scur [LFBS]: current sessions
13941 5. smax [LFBS]: max sessions
13942 6. slim [LFBS]: configured session limit
13943 7. stot [LFBS]: cumulative number of connections
13944 8. bin [LFBS]: bytes in
13945 9. bout [LFBS]: bytes out
13946 10. dreq [LFB.]: requests denied because of security concerns.
13947 - For tcp this is because of a matched tcp-request content rule.
13948 - For http this is because of a matched http-request or tarpit rule.
13949 11. dresp [LFBS]: responses denied because of security concerns.
13950 - For http this is because of a matched http-request rule, or
13951 "option checkcache".
13952 12. ereq [LF..]: request errors. Some of the possible causes are:
13953 - early termination from the client, before the request has been sent.
13954 - read error from the client
13955 - client timeout
13956 - client closed connection
13957 - various bad requests from the client.
13958 - request was tarpitted.
13959 13. econ [..BS]: number of requests that encountered an error trying to
13960 connect to a backend server. The backend stat is the sum of the stat
13961 for all servers of that backend, plus any connection errors not
13962 associated with a particular server (such as the backend having no
13963 active servers).
13964 14. eresp [..BS]: response errors. srv_abrt will be counted here also.
13965 Some other errors are:
13966 - write error on the client socket (won't be counted for the server stat)
13967 - failure applying filters to the response.
13968 15. wretr [..BS]: number of times a connection to a server was retried.
13969 16. wredis [..BS]: number of times a request was redispatched to another
13970 server. The server value counts the number of times that server was
13971 switched away from.
13972 17. status [LFBS]: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
13973 18. weight [..BS]: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
13974 19. act [..BS]: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
13975 20. bck [..BS]: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
13976 21. chkfail [...S]: number of failed checks. (Only counts checks failed when
13977 the server is up.)
13978 22. chkdown [..BS]: number of UP->DOWN transitions. The backend counter counts
13979 transitions to the whole backend being down, rather than the sum of the
13980 counters for each server.
13981 23. lastchg [..BS]: number of seconds since the last UP<->DOWN transition
13982 24. downtime [..BS]: total downtime (in seconds). The value for the backend
13983 is the downtime for the whole backend, not the sum of the server downtime.
13984 25. qlimit [...S]: configured maxqueue for the server, or nothing in the
13985 value is 0 (default, meaning no limit)
13986 26. pid [LFBS]: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
13987 27. iid [LFBS]: unique proxy id
13988 28. sid [L..S]: server id (unique inside a proxy)
13989 29. throttle [...S]: current throttle percentage for the server, when
13990 slowstart is active, or no value if not in slowstart.
13991 30. lbtot [..BS]: total number of times a server was selected, either for new
13992 sessions, or when re-dispatching. The server counter is the number
13993 of times that server was selected.
13994 31. tracked [...S]: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled.
13995 32. type [LFBS]: (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket/listener)
13996 33. rate [.FBS]: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
13997 34. rate_lim [.F..]: configured limit on new sessions per second
13998 35. rate_max [.FBS]: max number of new sessions per second
13999 36. check_status [...S]: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014000 UNK -> unknown
14001 INI -> initializing
14002 SOCKERR -> socket error
14003 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
14004 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
14005 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
14006 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
14007 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
14008 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
14009 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
14010 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
14011 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
14012 disable-on-404
14013 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
14014 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
14015 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040014016 37. check_code [...S]: layer5-7 code, if available
14017 38. check_duration [...S]: time in ms took to finish last health check
14018 39. hrsp_1xx [.FBS]: http responses with 1xx code
14019 40. hrsp_2xx [.FBS]: http responses with 2xx code
14020 41. hrsp_3xx [.FBS]: http responses with 3xx code
14021 42. hrsp_4xx [.FBS]: http responses with 4xx code
14022 43. hrsp_5xx [.FBS]: http responses with 5xx code
14023 44. hrsp_other [.FBS]: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
14024 45. hanafail [...S]: failed health checks details
14025 46. req_rate [.F..]: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
14026 47. req_rate_max [.F..]: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
14027 48. req_tot [.F..]: total number of HTTP requests received
14028 49. cli_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the client
14029 50. srv_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the server
14030 (inc. in eresp)
14031 51. comp_in [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
14032 52. comp_out [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
14033 53. comp_byp [.FB.]: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor
14034 (CPU/BW limit)
14035 54. comp_rsp [.FB.]: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
14036 55. lastsess [..BS]: number of seconds since last session assigned to
14037 server/backend
14038 56. last_chk [...S]: last health check contents or textual error
14039 57. last_agt [...S]: last agent check contents or textual error
14040 58. qtime [..BS]: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14041 59. ctime [..BS]: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14042 60. rtime [..BS]: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14043 (0 for TCP)
14044 61. ttime [..BS]: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last
14045 requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014046
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014047
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140489.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014049-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014050
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020014051The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
14052necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
14053A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
14054issuing commands by hand :
14055
14056 global
14057 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
14058 stats timeout 2m
14059
14060It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
14061the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
14062never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
14063situations :
14064
14065 global
14066 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
14067 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
14068 stats timeout 2m
14069
14070To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
14071swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
14072to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
14073syntaxes we'll use are the following :
14074
14075 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
14076 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
14077
14078The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
14079script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
14080for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
14081
14082The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
14083that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
14084editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
14085(eg: watch a counter).
14086
14087The socket supports two operation modes :
14088 - interactive
14089 - non-interactive
14090
14091The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
14092this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
14093sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
14094mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
14095commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
14096example :
14097
14098 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
14099
14100The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
14101entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
14102for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
14103sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
14104"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
14105after processing the last command of the same line.
14106
14107For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
14108"prompt" command :
14109
14110 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
14111 prompt
14112 > show info
14113 ...
14114 >
14115
14116Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
14117delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
14118that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
14119parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014120
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014121It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
14122on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
14123own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014124
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020014125The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
14126If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
14127all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
14128it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
14129
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014130add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014131 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
14132 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
14133 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
14134 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014135
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014136add map <map> <key> <value>
14137 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
14138 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014139 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
14140 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
14141 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014142
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014143clear counters
14144 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
14145 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
14146 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
14147 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
14148 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
14149
14150clear counters all
14151 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
14152 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
14153 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
14154
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014155clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014156 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
14157 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
14158 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014159
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014160clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014161 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
14162 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
14163 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014164
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014165clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
14166 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
14167
14168 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
14169 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
14170 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
14171 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
14172 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
14173 later after the session ends is usual enough.
14174
14175 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
14176
14177 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
14178 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
14179 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
14180 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
14181 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
14182 the ACLs :
14183
14184 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
14185 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
14186 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
14187 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
14188 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
14189 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
14190
14191 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090014192 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
14193 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014194
14195 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014196 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020014197 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014198 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
14199 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
14200 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14201 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014202
14203 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14204
14205 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020014206 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014207 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14208 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014209 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14210 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14211 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014212
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014213del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
14214 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014215 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
14216 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
14217 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
14218 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014219
14220del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010014221 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014222 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
14223 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
14224 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
14225 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010014226
14227disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090014228 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
14229
14230 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
14231 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
14232 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
14233 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
14234 re-enabled using enable agent.
14235
14236 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
14237 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
14238 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
14239 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
14240 otherwise unchanged.
14241
14242 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
14243 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
14244 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
14245
14246 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14247 level "admin".
14248
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020014249disable frontend <frontend>
14250 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
14251 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
14252 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
14253 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
14254 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
14255 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
14256 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
14257 on the stats page.
14258
14259 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14260 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14261
14262 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14263 level "admin".
14264
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020014265disable health <backend>/<server>
14266 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
14267 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
14268 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
14269 agent check forces it down.
14270
14271 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14272 level "admin".
14273
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014274disable server <backend>/<server>
14275 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
14276 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
14277 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
14278 during the maintenance.
14279
14280 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
14281 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
14282
14283 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020014284 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014285
14286 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14287 level "admin".
14288
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090014289enable agent <backend>/<server>
14290 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
14291
14292 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
14293 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
14294
14295 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14296 level "admin".
14297
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020014298enable frontend <frontend>
14299 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
14300 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
14301 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
14302 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
14303 which was disabled.
14304
14305 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14306 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14307
14308 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14309 level "admin".
14310
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020014311enable health <backend>/<server>
14312 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
14313 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
14314
14315 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14316 level "admin".
14317
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014318enable server <backend>/<server>
14319 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
14320 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
14321
14322 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020014323 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014324
14325 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14326 level "admin".
14327
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010014328get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014329get acl <acl> <value>
14330 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
14331 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
14332 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
14333 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
14334 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010014335
14336 The first two words are:
14337
14338 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
14339 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
14340 "dom", "end" or "reg".
14341
14342 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
14343
14344 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
14345
14346 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
14347
14348 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
14349 interpretation of the case.
14350
14351 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
14352 useful with regular expressions.
14353
14354 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
14355 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
14356
14357 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
14358 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
14359 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
14360
14361 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
14362
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014363get weight <backend>/<server>
14364 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
14365 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
14366 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
14367 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
14368 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020014369 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014370
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014371help
14372 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
14373 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014374
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014375prompt
14376 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
14377 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
14378 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
14379 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
14380 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
14381 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
14382 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
14383 command.
14384
14385quit
14386 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014387
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014388set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014389 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
14390 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
14391 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014392
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020014393set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020014394 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
14395 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
14396 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
14397 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
14398 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020014399 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
14400 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14401
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020014402set maxconn global <maxconn>
14403 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
14404 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
14405 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
14406 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
14407 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
14408 setting.
14409
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020014410set rate-limit connections global <value>
14411 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
14412 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14413 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14414 is passed in number of connections per second.
14415
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010014416set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
14417 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
14418 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010014419 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
14420 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010014421
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020014422set rate-limit sessions global <value>
14423 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
14424 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14425 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14426 is passed in number of sessions per second.
14427
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020014428set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
14429 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
14430 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14431 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14432 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
14433 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
14434
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020014435set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
14436 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
14437 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
14438 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
14439
14440set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
14441 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
14442 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
14443 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
14444
14445set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
14446 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
14447 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
14448 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
14449 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
14450 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
14451 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
14452 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
14453 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
14454
14455set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
14456 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
14457 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
14458
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020014459set ssl ocsp-response <response>
14460 This command is used to update an OCSP Response for a certificate (see "crt"
14461 on "bind" lines). Same controls are performed as during the initial loading of
14462 the response. The <response> must be passed as a base64 encoded string of the
14463 DER encoded response from the OCSP server.
14464
14465 Example:
14466 openssl ocsp -issuer issuer.pem -cert server.pem \
14467 -host ocsp.issuer.com:80 -respout resp.der
14468 echo "set ssl ocsp-response $(base64 -w 10000 resp.der)" | \
14469 socat stdio /var/run/haproxy.stat
14470
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020014471set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020014472 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
14473 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
14474 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
14475 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020014476 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
14477 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020014478
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014479set timeout cli <delay>
14480 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
14481 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
14482 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
14483
14484set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
14485 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
14486 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090014487 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
14488 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
14489 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
14490 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
14491 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
14492 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
14493 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
14494 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
14495 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
14496 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
14497 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
14498 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
14499 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014500
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014501show errors [<iid>]
14502 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
14503 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020014504 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
14505 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
14506 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014507
14508 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
14509 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
14510 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
14511 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
14512 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
14513 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
14514 are reported too.
14515
14516 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
14517 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
14518 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
14519 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
14520 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
14521 code.
14522
14523 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
14524 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
14525 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
14526 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
14527 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
14528 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
14529 line.
14530
14531 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014532 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14533 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014534 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
14535 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
14536
14537 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
14538 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
14539 00038 Location: blah\r\n
14540 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
14541 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
14542 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
14543 00204+ minal\r\n
14544 00211 \r\n
14545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014546 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014547 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
14548 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
14549 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
14550 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
14551 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
14552 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014553
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014554show info
14555 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
14556
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014557show map [<map>]
14558 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014559 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
14560 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
14561 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
14562 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
14563 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
14564 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014565
14566show acl [<acl>]
14567 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014568 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
14569 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
14570 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
14571 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
14572 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014573
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010014574show pools
14575 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
14576 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
14577 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
14578 the pools.
14579
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014580show sess
14581 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020014582 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
14583 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
14584
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010014585show sess <id>
14586 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
14587 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
14588 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
14589 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
14590 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Olivierce31e6e2014-09-05 18:49:10 +020014591 freely evolve depending on demands. You may find a description of all fields
14592 returned in src/dumpstats.c
14593
14594 The special id "all" dumps the states of all sessions, which must be avoided
14595 as much as possible as it is highly CPU intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014596
14597show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
14598 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
14599 possible to dump only selected items :
14600 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
14601 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
14602 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
14603 for example:
14604 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
14605 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
14606 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
14607
14608 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014609 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
14610 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014611 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
14612 Release_date: 2009/09/23
14613 Nbproc: 1
14614 Process_num: 1
14615 (...)
14616
14617 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
14618 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
14619 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
14620 (...)
14621 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
14622
14623 $
14624
14625 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
14626 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
14627 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
14628 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014629 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014630
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014631show table
14632 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
14633 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
14634 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
14635 entries currently in use.
14636
14637 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014638 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014639 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
14640 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014641
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014642show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014643 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
14644 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
14645 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014646 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
14647
14648 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
14649 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
14650 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
14651 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
14652 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
14653
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014654 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
14655 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
14656 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
14657 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
14658 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
14659 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
14660
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014661
14662 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090014663 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
14664 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014665
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014666 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014667 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014668 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014669 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
14670 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
14671 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14672 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014673
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014674 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014675 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014676 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14677 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014678
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014679 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
14680 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014681 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014682 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14683 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014684
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014685 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
14686 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014687 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014688 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14689 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
14690
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014691 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
14692 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
14693 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
14694 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
14695 time goes, the average event rate drops.
14696
14697 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
14698 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
14699 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014700 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
14701 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014702 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
14703 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020014704
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020014705shutdown frontend <frontend>
14706 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
14707 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
14708 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
14709 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
14710 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
14711 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
14712 once it is terminated.
14713
14714 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14715 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14716
14717 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14718 level "admin".
14719
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020014720shutdown session <id>
14721 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
14722 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
14723 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
14724 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
14725 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
14726 flag in the logs.
14727
Cyril Bontée63a1eb2014-07-12 18:22:42 +020014728shutdown sessions server <backend>/<server>
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020014729 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
14730 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
14731 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
14732 'K' flag in the logs.
14733
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014734/*
14735 * Local variables:
14736 * fill-column: 79
14737 * End:
14738 */